diff options
author | Drashna Jaelre <drashna@live.com> | 2019-08-02 14:02:40 -0700 |
---|---|---|
committer | skullydazed <skullydazed@users.noreply.github.com> | 2019-08-30 15:01:52 -0700 |
commit | cf4575b94a3c65e6535a159fc71fc885aebc2620 (patch) | |
tree | 2354f2b7a200e02246a564afefedc32357e62b8e /lib/lufa/Bootloaders | |
parent | 75ee8df19e0f14ba466f41ab673dde2fe2fdae9c (diff) |
Fix the LUFA lib to use a submodule instead of just files (#6245)
* Remove LUFA files
* Update descriptions for newer version of LUFA
* Create PR6245.md
* Fix CDC(Serial) type errors
* Fix missed merge conflict for AUDIO_DTYPE_CSInterface
Diffstat (limited to 'lib/lufa/Bootloaders')
72 files changed, 0 insertions, 23489 deletions
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c deleted file mode 100644 index 2be1568082..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,75 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Bootloader user application API functions. - */ - -#include "BootloaderAPI.h" - -void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_erase_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_write_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) -{ - boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) -{ - boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5169bbc3c4..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,58 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> - - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); - void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S deleted file mode 100644 index 2c60f84e8d..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S +++ /dev/null @@ -1,91 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the -; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) -.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines -BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: - - BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage - BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage - BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord - BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature - BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse - BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock - BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: - ret - - - -; API function jump table -.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable -BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: - - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 - - - -; Bootloader table signatures and information -.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures -BootloaderAPI_Signatures: - - .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader - .word 0xDF00 ; Signature for the CDC class bootloader - .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c deleted file mode 100644 index aa17bc15bd..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,673 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Main source file for the CDC class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. - */ - -#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C -#include "BootloaderCDC.h" - -/** Contains the current baud rate and other settings of the first virtual serial port. This must be retained as some - * operating systems will not open the port unless the settings can be set successfully. - */ -static CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding = { .BaudRateBPS = 0, - .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, - .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, - .DataBits = 8 }; - -/** Current address counter. This stores the current address of the FLASH or EEPROM as set by the host, - * and is used when reading or writing to the AVRs memory (either FLASH or EEPROM depending on the issued - * command.) - */ -static uint32_t CurrAddress; - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run - * via a watchdog reset. When cleared the bootloader will exit, starting the watchdog and entering an infinite - * loop until the AVR restarts and the application runs. - */ -static bool RunBootloader = true; - -/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader - * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held - * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value - * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. - */ -uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; - - -/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application - * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, - * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. - */ -void Application_Jump_Check(void) -{ - bool JumpToApplication = false; - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) - /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTC |= (1 << 7); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); - - /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ - PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); - #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) - /* Disable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_DISABLE(); - - /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTF |= (1 << 4); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); - - /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_ENABLE(); - #else - /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ - if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) - { - /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ - if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); - } - else - { - /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; - * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ - if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - } - #endif - - /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ - bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); - - /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ - if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) - { - /* Turn off the watchdog */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ - MagicBootKey = 0; - - // cppcheck-suppress constStatement - ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); - } -} - -/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously - * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start - * the loaded application code. - */ -int main(void) -{ - /* Setup hardware required for the bootloader */ - SetupHardware(); - - /* Turn on first LED on the board to indicate that the bootloader has started */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1); - - /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ - GlobalInterruptEnable(); - - while (RunBootloader) - { - CDC_Task(); - USB_USBTask(); - } - - /* Wait a short time to end all USB transactions and then disconnect */ - _delay_us(1000); - - /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ - USB_Detach(); - - /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ - MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; - - /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ - wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); - - for (;;); -} - -/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ -static void SetupHardware(void) -{ - /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Disable clock division */ - clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); - - /* Initialize the USB and other board hardware drivers */ - USB_Init(); - LEDs_Init(); - - /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ - TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); - TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); -} - -/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ -ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) -{ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready - * to relay data to and from the attached USB host. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) -{ - /* Setup CDC Notification, Rx and Tx Endpoints */ - Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, - CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); - - Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); - - Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to - * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing - * internally. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) -{ - /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the CDC interface */ - if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != - (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - return; - } - - /* Activity - toggle indicator LEDs */ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); - - /* Process CDC specific control requests */ - switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) - { - case CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding: - if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Write the line coding data to the control endpoint */ - Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - } - - break; - case CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding: - if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Read the line coding data in from the host into the global struct */ - Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - } - - break; - case CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState: - if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - } - - break; - } -} - -#if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) -/** Reads or writes a block of EEPROM or FLASH memory to or from the appropriate CDC data endpoint, depending - * on the AVR109 protocol command issued. - * - * \param[in] Command Single character AVR109 protocol command indicating what memory operation to perform - */ -static void ReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command) -{ - uint16_t BlockSize; - char MemoryType; - - uint8_t HighByte = 0; - uint8_t LowByte = 0; - - BlockSize = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8); - BlockSize |= FetchNextCommandByte(); - - MemoryType = FetchNextCommandByte(); - - if ((MemoryType != MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) && (MemoryType != MEMORY_TYPE_EEPROM)) - { - /* Send error byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('?'); - - return; - } - - /* Check if command is to read a memory block */ - if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead) - { - /* Re-enable RWW section */ - boot_rww_enable(); - - while (BlockSize--) - { - if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) - { - /* Read the next FLASH byte from the current FLASH page */ - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte_far(CurrAddress | HighByte)); - #else - WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte(CurrAddress | HighByte)); - #endif - - /* If both bytes in current word have been read, increment the address counter */ - if (HighByte) - CurrAddress += 2; - - HighByte = !HighByte; - } - else - { - /* Read the next EEPROM byte into the endpoint */ - WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)(intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1))); - - /* Increment the address counter after use */ - CurrAddress += 2; - } - } - } - else - { - uint32_t PageStartAddress = CurrAddress; - - if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) - { - boot_page_erase(PageStartAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - } - - while (BlockSize--) - { - if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) - { - /* If both bytes in current word have been written, increment the address counter */ - if (HighByte) - { - /* Write the next FLASH word to the current FLASH page */ - boot_page_fill(CurrAddress, ((FetchNextCommandByte() << 8) | LowByte)); - - /* Increment the address counter after use */ - CurrAddress += 2; - } - else - { - LowByte = FetchNextCommandByte(); - } - - HighByte = !HighByte; - } - else - { - /* Write the next EEPROM byte from the endpoint */ - eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)), FetchNextCommandByte()); - - /* Increment the address counter after use */ - CurrAddress += 2; - } - } - - /* If in FLASH programming mode, commit the page after writing */ - if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) - { - /* Commit the flash page to memory */ - boot_page_write(PageStartAddress); - - /* Wait until write operation has completed */ - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - } - - /* Send response byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } -} -#endif - -/** Retrieves the next byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint, and clears the endpoint bank if needed - * to allow reception of the next data packet from the host. - * - * \return Next received byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint - */ -static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void) -{ - /* Select the OUT endpoint so that the next data byte can be read */ - Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); - - /* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */ - while (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) - { - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return 0; - } - } - - /* Fetch the next byte from the OUT endpoint */ - return Endpoint_Read_8(); -} - -/** Writes the next response byte to the CDC data IN endpoint, and sends the endpoint back if needed to free up the - * bank when full ready for the next byte in the packet to the host. - * - * \param[in] Response Next response byte to send to the host - */ -static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response) -{ - /* Select the IN endpoint so that the next data byte can be written */ - Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); - - /* If IN endpoint full, clear it and wait until ready for the next packet to the host */ - if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) - { - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - - /* Write the next byte to the IN endpoint */ - Endpoint_Write_8(Response); -} - -/** Task to read in AVR109 commands from the CDC data OUT endpoint, process them, perform the required actions - * and send the appropriate response back to the host. - */ -static void CDC_Task(void) -{ - /* Select the OUT endpoint */ - Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); - - /* Check if endpoint has a command in it sent from the host */ - if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - return; - - /* Read in the bootloader command (first byte sent from host) */ - uint8_t Command = FetchNextCommandByte(); - - if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ExitBootloader) - { - RunBootloader = false; - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SetLED) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ClearLED) || - (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SelectDeviceType)) - { - FetchNextCommandByte(); - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_EnterProgrammingMode) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_LeaveProgrammingMode)) - { - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadPartCode) - { - /* Return ATMEGA128 part code - this is only to allow AVRProg to use the bootloader */ - WriteNextResponseByte(0x44); - WriteNextResponseByte(0x00); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadAutoAddressIncrement) - { - /* Indicate auto-address increment is supported */ - WriteNextResponseByte('Y'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SetCurrentAddress) - { - /* Set the current address to that given by the host (translate 16-bit word address to byte address) */ - CurrAddress = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 9); - CurrAddress |= (FetchNextCommandByte() << 1); - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderInterface) - { - /* Indicate serial programmer back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('S'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderIdentifier) - { - /* Write the 7-byte software identifier to the endpoint */ - for (uint8_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < 7; CurrByte++) - WriteNextResponseByte(SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER[CurrByte]); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderSWVersion) - { - WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR); - WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadSignature) - { - WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_3); - WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_2); - WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_1); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_EraseFLASH) - { - /* Clear the application section of flash */ - for (uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR; CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE) - { - boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - } - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - #if !defined(NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT) - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteLockbits) - { - /* Set the lock bits to those given by the host */ - boot_lock_bits_set(FetchNextCommandByte()); - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - #endif - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLockbits) - { - WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS)); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLowFuses) - { - WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOW_FUSE_BITS)); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadHighFuses) - { - WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS)); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadExtendedFuses) - { - WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_EXTENDED_FUSE_BITS)); - } - #if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_GetBlockWriteSupport) - { - WriteNextResponseByte('Y'); - - /* Send block size to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE >> 8); - WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE & 0xFF); - } - else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockWrite) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead)) - { - /* Delegate the block write/read to a separate function for clarity */ - ReadWriteMemoryBlock(Command); - } - #endif - #if !defined(NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT) - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordHigh) - { - /* Write the high byte to the current flash page */ - boot_page_fill(CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte()); - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordLow) - { - /* Write the low byte to the current flash page */ - boot_page_fill(CurrAddress | 0x01, FetchNextCommandByte()); - - /* Increment the address */ - CurrAddress += 2; - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteFlashPage) - { - /* Commit the flash page to memory */ - boot_page_write(CurrAddress); - - /* Wait until write operation has completed */ - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadFLASHWord) - { - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word_far(CurrAddress); - #else - uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word(CurrAddress); - #endif - - WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord >> 8); - WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord & 0xFF); - } - #endif - #if !defined(NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT) - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteEEPROM) - { - /* Read the byte from the endpoint and write it to the EEPROM */ - eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)), FetchNextCommandByte()); - - /* Increment the address after use */ - CurrAddress += 2; - - /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ - WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); - } - else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadEEPROM) - { - /* Read the EEPROM byte and write it to the endpoint */ - WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)))); - - /* Increment the address after use */ - CurrAddress += 2; - } - #endif - else if (Command != AVR109_COMMAND_Sync) - { - /* Unknown (non-sync) command, return fail code */ - WriteNextResponseByte('?'); - } - - /* Select the IN endpoint */ - Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); - - /* Remember if the endpoint is completely full before clearing it */ - bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); - - /* Send the endpoint data to the host */ - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - /* If a full endpoint's worth of data was sent, we need to send an empty packet afterwards to signal end of transfer */ - if (IsEndpointFull) - { - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - } - - /* Wait until the data has been sent to the host */ - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - /* Select the OUT endpoint */ - Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); - - /* Acknowledge the command from the host */ - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h deleted file mode 100644 index b6543aa738..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,144 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderCDC.c. - */ - -#ifndef _CDC_H_ -#define _CDC_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/wdt.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <avr/eeprom.h> - #include <avr/power.h> - #include <avr/interrupt.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include "Descriptors.h" - #include "BootloaderAPI.h" - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> - #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> - - /* Preprocessor Checks: */ - #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) - #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. - #endif - - /* Macros: */ - /** Version major of the CDC bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR 0x01 - - /** Version minor of the CDC bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 0x00 - - /** Hardware version major of the CDC bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MAJOR 0x01 - - /** Hardware version minor of the CDC bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MINOR 0x00 - - /** Eight character bootloader firmware identifier reported to the host when requested. */ - #define SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER "LUFACDC" - - /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ - #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 - - /* Enums: */ - /** Possible memory types that can be addressed via the bootloader. */ - enum AVR109_Memories - { - MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH = 'F', - MEMORY_TYPE_EEPROM = 'E', - }; - - /** Possible commands that can be issued to the bootloader. */ - enum AVR109_Commands - { - AVR109_COMMAND_Sync = 27, - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadEEPROM = 'd', - AVR109_COMMAND_WriteEEPROM = 'D', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadFLASHWord = 'R', - AVR109_COMMAND_WriteFlashPage = 'm', - AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordLow = 'c', - AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordHigh = 'C', - AVR109_COMMAND_GetBlockWriteSupport = 'b', - AVR109_COMMAND_BlockWrite = 'B', - AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead = 'g', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadExtendedFuses = 'Q', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadHighFuses = 'N', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLowFuses = 'F', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLockbits = 'r', - AVR109_COMMAND_WriteLockbits = 'l', - AVR109_COMMAND_EraseFLASH = 'e', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadSignature = 's', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderSWVersion = 'V', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderHWVersion = 'v', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderIdentifier = 'S', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderInterface = 'p', - AVR109_COMMAND_SetCurrentAddress = 'A', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadAutoAddressIncrement = 'a', - AVR109_COMMAND_ReadPartCode = 't', - AVR109_COMMAND_EnterProgrammingMode = 'P', - AVR109_COMMAND_LeaveProgrammingMode = 'L', - AVR109_COMMAND_SelectDeviceType = 'T', - AVR109_COMMAND_SetLED = 'x', - AVR109_COMMAND_ClearLED = 'y', - AVR109_COMMAND_ExitBootloader = 'E', - }; - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for a non-returning pointer to the start of the loaded application in flash memory. */ - typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - static void CDC_Task(void); - static void SetupHardware(void); - - void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); - - void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); - - #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) - #if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) - static void ReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command); - #endif - static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void); - static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response); - #endif - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt deleted file mode 100644 index f8c349cded..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,242 +0,0 @@ -/** \file - * - * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special - * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. - */ - -/** \mainpage CDC Class USB AVR Bootloader - * - * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: - * - * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. - * - * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) - * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) - * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - * - * \section Sec_Info USB Information: - * - * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> - * <td>Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> - * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> - * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> - * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> - * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - * - * \section Sec_Description Project Description: - * - * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a CDC Class device (virtual serial port), allowing for AVR109 - * protocol compatible programming software to load firmware onto the AVR. - * - * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit - * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to - * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. - * - * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the - * bootloader from the normal user application. - * - * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device - * lockbits are set. - * - * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader - * - * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of - * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. - * - * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from - * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the - * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software - * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). - * - * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. - * - * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board - * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the - * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board - * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the - * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation - * - * After running this bootloader for the first time on a new computer, you will need to supply the .INF - * file located in this bootloader project's directory as the device's driver when running under Windows. - * This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, negating the need for custom drivers for the - * device. Other Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt CDC-ACM drivers. - * - * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application - * - * This bootloader is compatible with the open source application AVRDUDE, Atmel's AVRPROG, or other - * applications implementing the AVR109 protocol, which is documented on the Atmel website as an application - * note. - * - * \subsection SSec_AVRDude AVRDUDE (Windows, Mac, Linux) - * - * AVRDude is a free, cross-platform and open source command line programmer for Atmel and third party AVR - * programmers. It is available on the the Windows platform as part of the "WinAVR" package, or on other systems - * either from a build from the official source code, or in many distributions as a precompiled binary package. - * - * To load a new HEX file with AVRDude, specify "AVR109" as the programmer, with the allocated COM port. On Windows - * platforms this will be a COMx port name: - * \code - * avrdude -c AVR109 -p at90usb1287 -P COM0 -U flash:w:Mouse.hex - * \endcode - * - * On Linux systems, this will typically be a /dev/ttyACMx port name: - * \code - * avrdude -c AVR109 -p at90usb1287 -P /dev/ttyACM0 -U flash:w:Mouse.hex - * \endcode - * - * Refer to the AVRDude project documentation for additional usage instructions. - * - * \section Sec_API User Application API - * - * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, - * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. - * - * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the - * following layout: - * - * \code - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) - * - * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_CDC_SIGNATURE 0xDF00 - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 - * \endcode - * - * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address - * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader - * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them - * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_CDC_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH - * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. - * - * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map - * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. - * - * \verbatim - * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | User Application | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - * | | - * | Bootloader Application | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 - * | API Table Trampolines | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 - * | Bootloader API Table | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 - * | Bootloader ID Constants | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - * \endverbatim - * - * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: - * - * \par On Linux machines, the CDC bootloader is unstable or inaccessible. - * A change to the \c ModemManager module in many Linux distributions causes - * this module to try to take control over inserted CDC devices, corrupting the - * datastream. A UDEV rule is required to prevent this. - * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. - * If the issue still persists then uninstall modemmanager by executing <tt>sudo apt-get remove modemmanager</tt>, or - * the equivalent using your chosen distribution's package manager. - * - * \par On Linux machines, the CDC bootloader is inaccessible. - * On many Linux systems, non-root users do not have automatic access to newly - * inserted CDC devices. Root privileges or a UDEV rule is required to gain - * access. - * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. - * - * \section Sec_Options Project Options - * - * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> - * <th><b>Location:</b></th> - * <th><b>Description:</b></th> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>Define to disable memory block read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all reads and writes to be made - * using the byte-level commands.</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>Define to disable EEPROM memory byte read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all EEPROM reads and writes - * to be made using the block-level commands.</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>Define to disable FLASH memory byte read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all FLASH reads and writes - * to be made using the block-level commands.</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>Define to disable lock byte write support in the bootloader, preventing the lock bits from being set programmatically.</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - */ - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 22972b72fe..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,50 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief Application Configuration Header File - * - * This is a header file which is be used to configure LUFA's - * compile time options, as an alternative to the compile time - * constants supplied through a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the - * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. - */ - -#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ -#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ - -// #define NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT -// #define NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT -// #define NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT -// #define NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT - -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5aa0e765bf..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,93 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File - * - * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, - * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through - * a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA - * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". - */ - -#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ -#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ - - #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) - - /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ -// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES - - /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY -// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH - - /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG - #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) - #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY -// #define USB_HOST_ONLY -// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT - #define NO_SOF_EVENTS - - /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS - #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL - #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 - #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 - #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 -// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE -// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT - #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP - #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER - - /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} -// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT -// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE - - #else - - #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. - - #endif -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6276570373..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,244 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special - * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine - * the device's capabilities and functions. - */ - -#include "Descriptors.h" - -/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall - * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the - * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration - * process begins. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = -{ - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, - - .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, - .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, - .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, - - .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, - - .VendorID = 0x03EB, - .ProductID = 0x204A, - .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), - - .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, - .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, - .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS -}; - -/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage - * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces - * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting - * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = -{ - .Config = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, - - .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), - .TotalInterfaces = 2, - - .ConfigurationNumber = 1, - .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, - - .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) - }, - - .CDC_CCI_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, - .AlternateSetting = 0, - - .TotalEndpoints = 1, - - .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, - .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, - .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .CDC_Functional_Header = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, - .Subtype = 0x00, - - .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - }, - - .CDC_Functional_ACM = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, - .Subtype = 0x02, - - .Capabilities = 0x02, - }, - - .CDC_Functional_Union = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, - .Subtype = 0x06, - - .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, - .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, - }, - - .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF - }, - - .CDC_DCI_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, - .AlternateSetting = 0, - - .TotalEndpoints = 2, - - .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, - .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, - .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - }, - - .CDC_DataInEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - } -}; - -/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests - * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate - * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); - -/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable - * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); - -/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, - * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC"); - -/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see LUFA library "USB Descriptors" - * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given - * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function - * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the - * USB host. - */ -uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) -{ - const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); - const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); - - const void* Address = NULL; - uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; - - switch (DescriptorType) - { - case DTYPE_Device: - Address = &DeviceDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); - break; - case DTYPE_Configuration: - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); - break; - case DTYPE_String: - if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Language) - { - Address = &LanguageString; - Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; - } - else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Manufacturer) - { - Address = &ManufacturerString; - Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; - } - else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Product) - { - Address = &ProductString; - Size = ProductString.Header.Size; - } - - break; - } - - *DescriptorAddress = Address; - return Size; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h deleted file mode 100644 index a6fbf5262b..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,158 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for Descriptors.c. - */ - -#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ -#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - /* Macros: */ - #if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x87 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x88 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x8A - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #else - #error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader. - #endif - - /** Endpoint address for the CDC control interface event notification endpoint. */ - #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) - - /** Endpoint address for the CDC data interface TX (data IN) endpoint. */ - #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) - - /** Endpoint address for the CDC data interface RX (data OUT) endpoint. */ - #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) - - /** Size of the CDC data interface TX and RX data endpoint banks, in bytes. */ - #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 - - /** Size of the CDC control interface notification endpoint bank, in bytes. */ - #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the - * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which - * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; - - // CDC Control Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; - USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; - USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; - USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; - - // CDC Data Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; - } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; - - /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor - * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the - * interface from other descriptors. - */ - enum InterfaceDescriptors_t - { - INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ - INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ - }; - - /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should - * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from - * other descriptors. - */ - enum StringDescriptors_t - { - STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ - STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ - STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) - ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 61624c7318..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,66 +0,0 @@ -;************************************************************ -; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File -; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation -;************************************************************ - -[DefaultInstall] -CopyINF="LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf" - -[Version] -Signature="$Windows NT$" -Class=Ports -ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} -Provider=%MFGNAME% -DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 - -[Manufacturer] -%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 - -[SourceDisksNames] - -[SourceDisksFiles] - -[DestinationDirs] -DefaultDestDir=12 - -[DriverInstall] -Include=mdmcpq.inf -CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection -AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg - -[DriverInstall.Services] -Include=mdmcpq.inf -AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst - -[DriverInstall.AddReg] -HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" - -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -; Vendor and Product ID Definitions -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side -; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. -; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. -; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. -; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -[DeviceList] -%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A - -[DeviceList.NTx86] -%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A - -[DeviceList.NTamd64] -%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A - -[DeviceList.NTia64] -%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A - -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -; String Definitions -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -;Modify these strings to customize your device -;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ -[Strings] -MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" -DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC Class Bootloader" diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 02e7063c66..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,161 +0,0 @@ -<asf xmlversion="1.0"> - <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_128kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_64kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb647"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_32kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega32u4"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_16kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega16u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_8kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega8u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc" caption="CDC Bootloader"> - <info type="description" value="summary"> - CDC Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device using avrdude or other AVR109 protocol compliant software when plugged into a host. - </info> - - <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> - - <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> - <keyword value="Bootloaders"/> - <keyword value="USB Device"/> - </info> - - <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="."/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderCDC.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderCDC.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/> - <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/> - - <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> - - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderCDC.txt"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf"/> - - <require idref="lufa.common"/> - <require idref="lufa.platform"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> - </module> -</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile deleted file mode 100644 index 414693479f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2396 +0,0 @@ -# Doxyfile 1.8.9 - -# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system -# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. -# -# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in -# front of the TAG it is preceding. -# -# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. -# The format is: -# TAG = value [value, ...] -# For lists, items can also be appended using: -# TAG += value [value, ...] -# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Project related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file -# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text -# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv -# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv -# for the list of possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by -# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the -# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the -# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. -# The default value is: My Project. - -PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - CDC Class Bootloader" - -# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This -# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version -# control system is used. - -PROJECT_NUMBER = - -# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description -# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a -# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. - -PROJECT_BRIEF = - -# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included -# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 -# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy -# the logo to the output directory. - -PROJECT_LOGO = - -# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path -# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is -# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If -# left blank the current directory will be used. - -OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ - -# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- -# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and -# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this -# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where -# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes -# performance problems for the file system. -# The default value is: NO. - -CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO - -# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII -# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII -# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode -# U+3044. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO - -# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all -# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this -# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. -# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, -# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), -# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, -# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), -# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, -# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, -# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, -# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. -# The default value is: English. - -OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English - -# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member -# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class -# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. -# The default value is: YES. - -BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES - -# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief -# description of a member or function before the detailed description -# -# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the -# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. -# The default value is: YES. - -REPEAT_BRIEF = YES - -# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is -# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found -# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text -# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated -# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the -# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of -# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, -# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. - -ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ - "The $name widget" \ - "The $name file" \ - is \ - provides \ - specifies \ - contains \ - represents \ - a \ - an \ - the - -# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then -# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief -# description. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO - -# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all -# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those -# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment -# operators of the base classes will not be shown. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO - -# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path -# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the -# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used -# The default value is: YES. - -FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES - -# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. -# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand -# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. -# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to -# strip. -# -# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which -# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. -# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. - -STRIP_FROM_PATH = - -# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the -# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which -# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of -# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should -# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler -# using the -I flag. - -STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = - -# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but -# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't -# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHORT_NAMES = YES - -# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the -# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief -# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- -# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief -# description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first -# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If -# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus -# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a -# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as -# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is -# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this -# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. -# -# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are -# not recognized any more. -# The default value is: NO. - -MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO - -# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the -# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. -# The default value is: YES. - -INHERIT_DOCS = YES - -# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new -# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part -# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. -# The default value is: NO. - -SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO - -# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen -# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. - -TAB_SIZE = 4 - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in -# the documentation. An alias has the form: -# name=value -# For example adding -# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" -# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the -# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading -# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert -# newlines. - -ALIASES = - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). -# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" -# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. - -TCL_SUBST = - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources -# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For -# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all -# members will be omitted, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or -# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored -# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, -# qualified scopes will look different, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO - -# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it -# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given -# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it -# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and -# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, -# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: -# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: -# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed -# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For -# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), -# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. -# -# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. -# -# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise -# the files are not read by doxygen. - -EXTENSION_MAPPING = - -# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments -# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable -# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. -# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can -# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in -# case of backward compatibilities issues. -# The default value is: YES. - -MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO - -# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented -# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can -# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or -# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES - -# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want -# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this -# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and -# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); -# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration -# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. -# The default value is: NO. - -BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO - -# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to -# enable parsing support. -# The default value is: NO. - -CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO - -# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: -# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen -# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead -# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. -# The default value is: NO. - -SIP_SUPPORT = NO - -# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate -# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make -# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. -# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple -# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you -# should set this option to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES - -# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC -# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first -# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default -# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. -# The default value is: NO. - -DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO - -# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type -# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that -# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent -# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the -# \nosubgrouping command. -# The default value is: YES. - -SUBGROUPING = YES - -# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions -# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) -# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX -# and RTF). -# -# Note that this feature does not work in combination with -# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO - -# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions -# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in -# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, -# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set -# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and -# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO - -# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or -# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So -# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct -# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, -# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be -# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound -# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. -# The default value is: NO. - -TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO - -# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This -# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be -# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the -# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small -# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The -# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range -# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 -# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest -# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. - -LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Build related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in -# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private -# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the -# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. -# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are -# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ALL = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will -# be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal -# scope will be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO - -# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_STATIC = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined -# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, -# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect -# for Java sources. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES - -# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, -# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are -# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are -# included. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO - -# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be -# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called -# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of -# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace -# are hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these -# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation -# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set -# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option -# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO - -# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend -# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO - -# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any -# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these -# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO - -# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a -# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation -# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INTERNAL_DOCS = NO - -# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file -# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also -# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ -# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows -# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. -# The default value is: system dependent. - -CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with -# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the -# scope will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will -# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to -# YES the compound reference will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO - -# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of -# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES - -# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each -# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader -# which file to include in order to use the member. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO - -# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include -# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. -# The default value is: NO. - -FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO - -# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the -# documentation for inline members. -# The default value is: YES. - -INLINE_INFO = YES - -# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. -# The default value is: YES. - -SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES - -# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief -# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that -# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO - -# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and -# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the -# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. -# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief -# member documentation. -# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting -# detailed member documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO - -# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy -# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will -# appear in their defined order. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO - -# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by -# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will -# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. -# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. -# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical -# list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO - -# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper -# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between -# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is -# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a -# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still -# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. -# The default value is: NO. - -STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO - -# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo -# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test -# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug -# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) -# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in -# the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES - -# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation -# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> -# ... \endcond blocks. - -ENABLED_SECTIONS = - -# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the -# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the -# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here -# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The -# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be -# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the -# documentation regardless of this setting. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. - -MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 - -# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at -# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the -# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_USED_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This -# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View -# (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces -# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the -# Folder Tree View (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES - -# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that -# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from -# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via -# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided -# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file -# version. For an example see the documentation. - -FILE_VERSION_FILTER = - -# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed -# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated -# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file -# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can -# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml -# will be used as the name of the layout file. -# -# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called -# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE -# tag is left empty. - -LAYOUT_FILE = - -# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing -# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib -# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool -# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. -# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using -# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the -# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. - -CITE_BIB_FILES = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to -# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the -# messages are off. -# The default value is: NO. - -QUIET = YES - -# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are -# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES -# this implies that the warnings are on. -# -# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARNINGS = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate -# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag -# will automatically be disabled. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for -# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters -# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using -# markup commands wrongly. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES - -# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that -# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return -# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete -# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES - -# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen -# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which -# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated -# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will -# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) -# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. - -WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" - -# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error -# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard -# error (stderr). - -WARN_LOGFILE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the input files -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain -# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or -# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with -# spaces. -# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. - -INPUT = ./ - -# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files -# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses -# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv -# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of -# possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the -# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, -# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, -# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, -# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, -# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. - -FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ - *.c \ - *.txt - -# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should -# be searched for input files as well. -# The default value is: NO. - -RECURSIVE = YES - -# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be -# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a -# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. -# -# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is -# run. - -EXCLUDE = Documentation/ - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or -# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded -# from the input. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude -# certain files from those directories. -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names -# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the -# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the -# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, -# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ - INCLUDE_FROM_* - -# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include -# command). - -EXAMPLE_PATH = - -# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all -# files are included. - -EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * - -# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be -# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands -# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO - -# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the -# \image command). - -IMAGE_PATH = - -# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should -# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program -# by executing (via popen()) the command: -# -# <filter> <input-file> -# -# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the -# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter -# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag -# will be ignored. -# -# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the -# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added -# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. - -INPUT_FILTER = - -# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern -# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the -# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter -# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how -# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the -# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. - -FILTER_PATTERNS = - -# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using -# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for -# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). -# The default value is: NO. - -FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO - -# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file -# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and -# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using -# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). -# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. - -FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = - -# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that -# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page -# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub -# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. - -USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to source browsing -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be -# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. -# -# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that -# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. -# The default value is: NO. - -SOURCE_BROWSER = NO - -# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, -# classes and enums directly into the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SOURCES = NO - -# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any -# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and -# Fortran comments will always remain visible. -# The default value is: YES. - -STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES - -# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented -# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function -# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCES_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set -# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and -# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will -# link to the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO - -# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the -# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, -# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this -# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you -# can opt to disable this feature. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES - -# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will -# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in -# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system -# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version -# 4.8.6 or higher. -# -# To use it do the following: -# - Install the latest version of global -# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file -# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree -# - Run doxygen as normal -# -# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these -# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). -# -# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to -# source code will now point to the output of htags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -USE_HTAGS = NO - -# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a -# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is -# specified. Set to NO to disable this. -# See also: Section \class. -# The default value is: YES. - -VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO - -# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the -# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the -# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template -# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type -# information. -# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was -# compiled with the --with-libclang option. -# The default value is: NO. - -CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO - -# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command -# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that -# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories -# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. -# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. - -CLANG_OPTIONS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all -# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of -# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. -# The default value is: YES. - -ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES - -# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in -# which the alphabetical index list will be split. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 - -# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will -# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag -# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored -# while generating the index headers. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -IGNORE_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the HTML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_HTML = YES - -# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_OUTPUT = html - -# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each -# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). -# The default value is: .html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html - -# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for -# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a -# standard header. -# -# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets -# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. -# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a -# default header using -# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css -# YourConfigFile -# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" -# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally -# uses. -# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the -# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description -# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_HEADER = - -# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each -# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard -# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default -# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer -# that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FOOTER = - -# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style -# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of -# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style -# sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as -# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become -# obsolete. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets -# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. -# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the -# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. -# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). For an example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note -# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the -# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these -# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the -# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_FILES = - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen -# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to -# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value -# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 -# purple, and 360 is red again. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors -# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A -# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the -# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 -# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output -# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents -# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not -# change the gamma. -# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 - -# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML -# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this -# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO - -# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML -# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the -# page has loaded. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES - -# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries -# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand -# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to -# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless -# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of -# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value -# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded -# tree by default. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 - -# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development -# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with -# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a -# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in -# that directory and running make install will install the docset in -# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at -# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html -# for more information. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_DOCSET = NO - -# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides -# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider -# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. -# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" - -# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation -# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. -# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify -# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style -# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. -# The default value is: Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher - -# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three -# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The -# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop -# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on -# Windows. -# -# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output -# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML -# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old -# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed -# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for -# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for -# compressed HTML files. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO - -# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm -# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be -# written to the html output directory. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_FILE = - -# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path -# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, -# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. -# The file has to be specified with full path. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -HHC_LOCATION = - -# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated -# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -GENERATE_CHI = NO - -# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) -# and project file content. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = - -# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated -# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it -# enables the Previous and Next buttons. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -BINARY_TOC = NO - -# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to -# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -TOC_EXPAND = YES - -# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and -# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that -# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help -# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_QHP = NO - -# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify -# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to -# the HTML output folder. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QCH_FILE = - -# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help -# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace -# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project - -# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt -# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual -# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- -# folders). -# The default value is: doc. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc - -# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom -# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = - -# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the -# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this -# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: -# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's -# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the -# generated .qhp file. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHG_LOCATION = - -# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To -# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in -# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs -# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory -# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. -# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO - -# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin -# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this -# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. - -ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might -# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The -# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top -# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables -# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation -# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -DISABLE_INDEX = YES - -# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index -# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag -# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like -# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this -# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required -# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the -# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can -# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style -# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at -# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has -# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting -# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES - -# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that -# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. -# -# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing -# in the overview section. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 - -# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used -# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 - -# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to -# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO - -# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in -# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful -# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML -# output directory to force them to be regenerated. -# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images -# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not -# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. -# -# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in -# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see -# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering -# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX -# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When -# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path -# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -USE_MATHJAX = NO - -# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for -# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: -# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. -# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best -# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. -# The default value is: HTML-CSS. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS - -# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML -# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory -# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory -# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then -# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax -# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing -# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of -# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. -# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest - -# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax -# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example -# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = - -# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces -# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site -# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an -# example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_CODEFILE = - -# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for -# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and -# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help -# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) -# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. -# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then -# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to -# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S -# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically -# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down -# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated -# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel -# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the -# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> -# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter -# option. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE = NO - -# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be -# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There -# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH -# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and -# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing -# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section -# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO - -# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP -# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file -# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an -# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the -# search results. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). -# -# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO - -# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server -# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and -# Searching" for details. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE_URL = - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed -# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the -# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. -# The default file is: searchdata.xml. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the -# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is -# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple -# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = - -# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen -# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are -# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a -# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of -# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: -# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_LATEX = NO - -# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_OUTPUT = latex - -# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be -# invoked. -# -# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating -# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is -# written to the output directory. -# The default file is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex - -# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate -# index for LaTeX. -# The default file is: makeindex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex - -# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -COMPACT_LATEX = NO - -# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the -# printer. -# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x -# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). -# The default value is: a4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PAPER_TYPE = a4wide - -# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names -# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for -# instance you can specify -# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times -# If left blank no extra packages will be included. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -EXTRA_PACKAGES = - -# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the -# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the -# default header to a separate file. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The -# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, -# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, -# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty -# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred -# to HTML_HEADER. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HEADER = - -# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the -# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See -# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what -# special commands can be used inside the footer. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_FOOTER = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created -# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen -# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output -# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or -# markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = - -# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is -# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will -# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This -# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES - -# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate -# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a -# higher quality PDF documentation. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -USE_PDFLATEX = YES - -# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode -# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running -# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used -# when generating formulas in HTML. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO - -# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the -# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO - -# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source -# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the -# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. -# The default value is: plain. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the RTF output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The -# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF -# readers/editors. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_RTF = NO - -# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: rtf. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_OUTPUT = rtf - -# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -COMPACT_RTF = NO - -# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will -# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML -# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online -# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those -# fields. -# -# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO - -# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config -# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, -# missing definitions are set to their default value. -# -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the -# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = - -# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is -# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated -# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = - -# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code -# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the man page output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for -# classes and files. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_MAN = NO - -# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by -# MAN_OUTPUT. -# The default directory is: man. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_OUTPUT = man - -# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated -# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number -# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is -# optional. -# The default value is: .3. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_EXTENSION = .3 - -# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within -# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by -# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_SUBDIR = - -# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it -# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real -# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without -# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_LINKS = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the XML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that -# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_XML = NO - -# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: xml. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_OUTPUT = xml - -# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program -# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to -# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size -# of the XML output. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files -# that can be used to generate PDF. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO - -# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. -# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in -# front of it. -# The default directory is: docbook. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook - -# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the -# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing -# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly -# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an -# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the -# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is -# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the Perl module output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module -# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# -# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary -# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI -# output from the Perl module output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_LATEX = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely -# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to -# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the -# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it -# just the same. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES - -# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are -# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful -# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't -# overwrite each other's variables. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the preprocessor -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all -# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. -# The default value is: YES. - -ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names -# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be -# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting -# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -MACRO_EXPANSION = YES - -# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then -# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and -# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES - -# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the -# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES - -# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the -# preprocessor. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_PATH = - -# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard -# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the -# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be -# used. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = - -# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are -# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. -# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or -# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" -# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or -# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ - PROGMEM \ - ATTR_NO_INIT - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this -# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The -# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED -# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the -# definition found in the source code. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = - -# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will -# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have -# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros -# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not -# removed. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to external references -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag -# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of -# a tag file without this location is as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... -# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... -# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the -# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use -# of tag files. -# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include -# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is -# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. - -TAGFILES = - -# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a -# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to -# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. - -GENERATE_TAGFILE = - -# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in -# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be -# listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLEXTERNALS = NO - -# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed -# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be -# listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES - -# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in -# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will -# be listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES - -# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script -# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). -# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. - -PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the dot tool -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram -# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to -# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT -# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more -# powerful graphs. -# The default value is: YES. - -CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO - -# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc -# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: -# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the -# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where -# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the -# default search path. - -MSCGEN_PATH = - -# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will -# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The -# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. -# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. - -DIA_PATH = - -# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance -# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. -# The default value is: YES. - -HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES - -# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is -# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: -# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent -# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is -# set to NO -# The default value is: NO. - -HAVE_DOT = NO - -# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed -# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of -# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value -# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing -# speed. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 - -# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen -# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make -# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a -# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by -# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. -# The default value is: Helvetica. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTNAME = - -# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of -# dot graphs. -# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with -# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set -# the path where dot can find it using this tag. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTPATH = - -# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. -# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CLASS_GRAPH = NO - -# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a -# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation -# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the -# class with other documented classes. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GROUP_GRAPHS = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and -# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling -# Language. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LOOK = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the -# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may -# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the -# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 -# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit -# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, -# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to -# 10. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 - -# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and -# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their -# instances. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO - -# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to -# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the -# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO - -# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are -# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing -# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callgraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALL_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callergraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALLER_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical -# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO - -# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the -# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The -# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the -# files in the directories. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO - -# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images -# generated by dot. -# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order -# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this -# requirement). -# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. -# The default value is: png. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png - -# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to -# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. -# -# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested -# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. -# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make -# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO - -# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be -# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_PATH = - -# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile -# command). -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOTFILE_DIRS = - -# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile -# command). - -MSCFILE_DIRS = - -# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile -# command). - -DIAFILE_DIRS = - -# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the -# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed -# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will -# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and -# will not generate output for the diagram. - -PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = - -# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by -# the !include statement in a plantuml block. - -PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = - -# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes -# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes -# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized -# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct -# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that -# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 - -# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs -# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the -# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay -# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 -# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also -# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 - -# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent -# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem -# to support this out of the box. -# -# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to -# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to -# read). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output -# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This -# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support -# this, this feature is disabled by default. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO - -# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page -# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated -# graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GENERATE_LEGEND = YES - -# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot -# files that are used to generate the various graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index aa5a2117df..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# -# -------------------------------------- -# LUFA Project Makefile. -# -------------------------------------- - -# Run "make help" for target help. - -MCU = at90usb1287 -ARCH = AVR8 -BOARD = USBKEY -F_CPU = 8000000 -F_USB = $(F_CPU) -OPTIMIZATION = s -TARGET = BootloaderCDC -SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) -LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA -CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) - -# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must -# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the -# device's fuses. -FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128 -BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8 - -# Bootloader address calculation formulas -# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. -CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) -BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) -BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) - -# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to -# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. -BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) - -# Default target -all: - -# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules -DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk - -# Include common DMBS build system modules -DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS -include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c deleted file mode 100644 index 491c506d0f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,76 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Bootloader user application API functions. - */ - -#include "BootloaderAPI.h" - -void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_erase_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_write_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) -{ - boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) -{ - boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5169bbc3c4..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,58 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> - - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); - void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S deleted file mode 100644 index 95fd8e5c37..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S +++ /dev/null @@ -1,91 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the -; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) -.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines -BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: - - BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage - BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage - BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord - BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature - BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse - BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock - BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: - ret - - - -; API function jump table -.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable -BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: - - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 - - - -; Bootloader table signatures and information -.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures -BootloaderAPI_Signatures: - - .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader - .word 0xDF10 ; Signature for the DFU class bootloader, V1 - .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c deleted file mode 100644 index a2307219ec..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,891 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Main source file for the DFU class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. - */ - -#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C -#include "BootloaderDFU.h" - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is currently running in secure mode, disallowing memory operations - * other than erase. This is initially set to the value set by SECURE_MODE, and cleared by the bootloader - * once a memory erase has completed in a bootloader session. - */ -static bool IsSecure = SECURE_MODE; - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run - * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application - * jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000 (or other location specified by the host). - */ -static bool RunBootloader = true; - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is waiting to exit. When the host requests the bootloader to exit and - * jump to the application address it specifies, it sends two sequential commands which must be properly - * acknowledged. Upon reception of the first the RunBootloader flag is cleared and the WaitForExit flag is set, - * causing the bootloader to wait for the final exit command before shutting down. - */ -static bool WaitForExit = false; - -/** Current DFU state machine state, one of the values in the DFU_State_t enum. */ -static uint8_t DFU_State = dfuIDLE; - -/** Status code of the last executed DFU command. This is set to one of the values in the DFU_Status_t enum after - * each operation, and returned to the host when a Get Status DFU request is issued. - */ -static uint8_t DFU_Status = OK; - -/** Data containing the DFU command sent from the host. */ -static DFU_Command_t SentCommand; - -/** Response to the last issued Read Data DFU command. Unlike other DFU commands, the read command - * requires a single byte response from the bootloader containing the read data when the next DFU_UPLOAD command - * is issued by the host. - */ -static uint8_t ResponseByte; - -/** Pointer to the start of the user application. By default this is 0x0000 (the reset vector), however the host - * may specify an alternate address when issuing the application soft-start command. - */ -static AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000; - -/** 64-bit flash page number. This is concatenated with the current 16-bit address on USB AVRs containing more than - * 64KB of flash memory. - */ -static uint8_t Flash64KBPage = 0; - -/** Memory start address, indicating the current address in the memory being addressed (either FLASH or EEPROM - * depending on the issued command from the host). - */ -static uint16_t StartAddr = 0x0000; - -/** Memory end address, indicating the end address to read from/write to in the memory being addressed (either FLASH - * of EEPROM depending on the issued command from the host). - */ -static uint16_t EndAddr = 0x0000; - -/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader - * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held - * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value - * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. - */ -uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; - - -/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application - * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, - * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. - */ -void Application_Jump_Check(void) -{ - bool JumpToApplication = false; - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) - /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTC |= (1 << 7); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); - - /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ - PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); - #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) - /* Disable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_DISABLE(); - - /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTF |= (1 << 4); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); - - /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_ENABLE(); - #else - /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ - if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) - { - /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ - //if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - // JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); - } - else - { - /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; - * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ - //if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - // JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - } - #endif - - /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ - bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); - - /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ - if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) - { - /* Turn off the watchdog */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ - MagicBootKey = 0; - - // cppcheck-suppress constStatement - ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); - } -} - -/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously - * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start - * the loaded application code. - */ -int main(void) -{ - /* Configure hardware required by the bootloader */ - SetupHardware(); - - /* Turn on first LED on the board to indicate that the bootloader has started */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); - - /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ - GlobalInterruptEnable(); - - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) - uint16_t keypress = 0; - #endif - - /* Run the USB management task while the bootloader is supposed to be running */ - while (RunBootloader || WaitForExit) { - USB_USBTask(); - #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) - bool pressed = (PIN(QMK_ESC_INPUT) & NUM(QMK_ESC_INPUT)); - if ((DFU_State == dfuIDLE) && (keypress > 5000) && pressed) { - break; - } - if (pressed) { - keypress++; - } else { - keypress = 0; - } - - #endif - } - - /* Reset configured hardware back to their original states for the user application */ - ResetHardware(); - - /* Start the user application */ - AppStartPtr(); -} - -/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ -static void SetupHardware(void) -{ - /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Disable clock division */ - clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) - // output setup - DDR(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT); - PORT(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT); - - // input setup - DDR(QMK_ESC_INPUT) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_INPUT); - #endif - - /* Initialize the USB and other board hardware drivers */ - USB_Init(); - LEDs_Init(); - - /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ - TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); - TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); - -} - -/** Resets all configured hardware required for the bootloader back to their original states. */ -static void ResetHardware(void) -{ - /* Shut down the USB and other board hardware drivers */ - USB_Disable(); - LEDs_Disable(); - - /* Disable Bootloader active LED toggle timer */ - TIMSK1 = 0; - TCCR1B = 0; - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = 0; - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) - DDR(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT) = PORT(QMK_ESC_OUTPUT) = DDR(QMK_ESC_INPUT) = PORT(QMK_ESC_INPUT) = 0; - #endif -} - -/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ -ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) -{ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to - * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing - * internally. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) -{ - /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the DFU interface */ - if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != - (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - return; - } - - /* Activity - toggle indicator LEDs */ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); - - /* Get the size of the command and data from the wLength value */ - SentCommand.DataSize = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; - - switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) - { - case DFU_REQ_DNLOAD: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Check if bootloader is waiting to terminate */ - if (WaitForExit) - { - /* Bootloader is terminating - process last received command */ - ProcessBootloaderCommand(); - - /* Indicate that the last command has now been processed - free to exit bootloader */ - WaitForExit = false; - } - - /* If the request has a data stage, load it into the command struct */ - if (SentCommand.DataSize) - { - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - /* First byte of the data stage is the DNLOAD request's command */ - SentCommand.Command = Endpoint_Read_8(); - - /* One byte of the data stage is the command, so subtract it from the total data bytes */ - SentCommand.DataSize--; - - /* Load in the rest of the data stage as command parameters */ - for (uint8_t DataByte = 0; (DataByte < sizeof(SentCommand.Data)) && - Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); DataByte++) - { - SentCommand.Data[DataByte] = Endpoint_Read_8(); - SentCommand.DataSize--; - } - - /* Process the command */ - ProcessBootloaderCommand(); - } - - /* Check if currently downloading firmware */ - if (DFU_State == dfuDNLOAD_IDLE) - { - if (!(SentCommand.DataSize)) - { - DFU_State = dfuIDLE; - } - else - { - /* Throw away the filler bytes before the start of the firmware */ - DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE); - - /* Throw away the packet alignment filler bytes before the start of the firmware */ - DiscardFillerBytes(StartAddr % FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE); - - /* Calculate the number of bytes remaining to be written */ - uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1); - - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Write flash - { - /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */ - uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1); - - union - { - uint16_t Words[2]; - uint32_t Long; - } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; - - uint32_t CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long; - uint8_t WordsInFlashPage = 0; - - while (WordsRemaining--) - { - /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ - if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) - { - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - - /* Write the next word into the current flash page */ - boot_page_fill(CurrFlashAddress.Long, Endpoint_Read_16_LE()); - - /* Adjust counters */ - WordsInFlashPage += 1; - CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2; - - /* See if an entire page has been written to the flash page buffer */ - if ((WordsInFlashPage == (SPM_PAGESIZE >> 1)) || !(WordsRemaining)) - { - /* Commit the flash page to memory */ - boot_page_write(CurrFlashPageStartAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - /* Check if programming incomplete */ - if (WordsRemaining) - { - CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long; - WordsInFlashPage = 0; - - /* Erase next page's temp buffer */ - boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - } - } - } - - /* Once programming complete, start address equals the end address */ - StartAddr = EndAddr; - - /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash */ - boot_rww_enable(); - } - else // Write EEPROM - { - while (BytesRemaining--) - { - /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ - if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) - { - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - - /* Read the byte from the USB interface and write to to the EEPROM */ - eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr, Endpoint_Read_8()); - - /* Adjust counters */ - StartAddr++; - } - } - - /* Throw away the currently unused DFU file suffix */ - DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE); - } - } - - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - - break; - case DFU_REQ_UPLOAD: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - if (DFU_State != dfuUPLOAD_IDLE) - { - if ((DFU_State == dfuERROR) && IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank Check - { - /* Blank checking is performed in the DFU_DNLOAD request - if we get here we've told the host - that the memory isn't blank, and the host is requesting the first non-blank address */ - Endpoint_Write_16_LE(StartAddr); - } - else - { - /* Idle state upload - send response to last issued command */ - Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseByte); - } - } - else - { - /* Determine the number of bytes remaining in the current block */ - uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1); - - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read FLASH - { - /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */ - uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1); - - union - { - uint16_t Words[2]; - uint32_t Long; - } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; - - while (WordsRemaining--) - { - /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ - if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) - { - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - - /* Read the flash word and send it via USB to the host */ - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - Endpoint_Write_16_LE(pgm_read_word_far(CurrFlashAddress.Long)); - #else - Endpoint_Write_16_LE(pgm_read_word(CurrFlashAddress.Long)); - #endif - - /* Adjust counters */ - CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2; - } - - /* Once reading is complete, start address equals the end address */ - StartAddr = EndAddr; - } - else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM - { - while (BytesRemaining--) - { - /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ - if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) - { - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - - /* Read the EEPROM byte and send it via USB to the host */ - Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr)); - - /* Adjust counters */ - StartAddr++; - } - } - - /* Return to idle state */ - DFU_State = dfuIDLE; - } - - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - case DFU_REQ_GETSTATUS: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - /* Write 8-bit status value */ - Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_Status); - - /* Write 24-bit poll timeout value */ - Endpoint_Write_8(0); - Endpoint_Write_16_LE(0); - - /* Write 8-bit state value */ - Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_State); - - /* Write 8-bit state string ID number */ - Endpoint_Write_8(0); - - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - case DFU_REQ_CLRSTATUS: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Reset the status value variable to the default OK status */ - DFU_Status = OK; - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - case DFU_REQ_GETSTATE: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - - /* Write the current device state to the endpoint */ - Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_State); - - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - case DFU_REQ_ABORT: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Reset the current state variable to the default idle state */ - DFU_State = dfuIDLE; - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - } -} - -/** Routine to discard the specified number of bytes from the control endpoint stream. This is used to - * discard unused bytes in the stream from the host, including the memory program block suffix. - * - * \param[in] NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to discard from the host from the control endpoint - */ -static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes) -{ - while (NumberOfBytes--) - { - if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) - { - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - /* Wait until next data packet received */ - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) - { - if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) - return; - } - } - else - { - Endpoint_Discard_8(); - } - } -} - -/** Routine to process an issued command from the host, via a DFU_DNLOAD request wrapper. This routine ensures - * that the command is allowed based on the current secure mode flag value, and passes the command off to the - * appropriate handler function. - */ -static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void) -{ - /* Check if device is in secure mode */ - if (IsSecure) - { - /* Don't process command unless it is a READ or chip erase command */ - if (!(((SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_WRITE) && - IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) || - (SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_READ))) - { - /* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */ - DFU_State = dfuERROR; - DFU_Status = errWRITE; - - /* Stall command */ - Endpoint_StallTransaction(); - - /* Don't process the command */ - return; - } - } - - /* Dispatch the required command processing routine based on the command type */ - switch (SentCommand.Command) - { - case COMMAND_PROG_START: - ProcessMemProgCommand(); - break; - case COMMAND_DISP_DATA: - ProcessMemReadCommand(); - break; - case COMMAND_WRITE: - ProcessWriteCommand(); - break; - case COMMAND_READ: - ProcessReadCommand(); - break; - case COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR: - if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03, 0x00)) // Set 64KB flash page command - Flash64KBPage = SentCommand.Data[2]; - - break; - } -} - -/** Routine to concatenate the given pair of 16-bit memory start and end addresses from the host, and store them - * in the StartAddr and EndAddr global variables. - */ -static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void) -{ - union - { - uint8_t Bytes[2]; - uint16_t Word; - } Address[2] = {{.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[2], SentCommand.Data[1]}}, - {.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}}; - - /* Load in the start and ending read addresses from the sent data packet */ - StartAddr = Address[0].Word; - EndAddr = Address[1].Word; -} - -/** Handler for a Memory Program command issued by the host. This routine handles the preparations needed - * to write subsequent data from the host into the specified memory. - */ -static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void) -{ - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Write FLASH command - IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Write EEPROM command - { - /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */ - LoadStartEndAddresses(); - - /* If FLASH is being written to, we need to pre-erase the first page to write to */ - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) - { - union - { - uint16_t Words[2]; - uint32_t Long; - } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; - - /* Erase the current page's temp buffer */ - boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - } - - /* Set the state so that the next DNLOAD requests reads in the firmware */ - DFU_State = dfuDNLOAD_IDLE; - } -} - -/** Handler for a Memory Read command issued by the host. This routine handles the preparations needed - * to read subsequent data from the specified memory out to the host, as well as implementing the memory - * blank check command. - */ -static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void) -{ - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Read FLASH command - IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM command - { - /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */ - LoadStartEndAddresses(); - - /* Set the state so that the next UPLOAD requests read out the firmware */ - DFU_State = dfuUPLOAD_IDLE; - } - else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank check FLASH command - { - uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; - - while (CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR) - { - /* Check if the current byte is not blank */ - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - if (pgm_read_byte_far(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF) - #else - if (pgm_read_byte(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF) - #endif - { - /* Save the location of the first non-blank byte for response back to the host */ - Flash64KBPage = (CurrFlashAddress >> 16); - StartAddr = CurrFlashAddress; - - /* Set state and status variables to the appropriate error values */ - DFU_State = dfuERROR; - DFU_Status = errCHECK_ERASED; - - break; - } - - CurrFlashAddress++; - } - } -} - -/** Handler for a Data Write command issued by the host. This routine handles non-programming commands such as - * bootloader exit (both via software jumps and hardware watchdog resets) and flash memory erasure. - */ -static void ProcessWriteCommand(void) -{ - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03)) // Start application - { - /* Indicate that the bootloader is terminating */ - WaitForExit = true; - - /* Check if data supplied for the Start Program command - no data executes the program */ - if (SentCommand.DataSize) - { - if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x01) // Start via jump - { - union - { - uint8_t Bytes[2]; - AppPtr_t FuncPtr; - } Address = {.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}; - - /* Load in the jump address into the application start address pointer */ - AppStartPtr = Address.FuncPtr; - } - } - else - { - if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x00) // Start via watchdog - { - /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ - MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; - - /* Start the watchdog to reset the AVR once the communications are finalized */ - wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); - } - else // Start via jump - { - /* Set the flag to terminate the bootloader at next opportunity if a valid application has been loaded */ - if (pgm_read_word_near(0) == 0xFFFF) - RunBootloader = false; - } - } - } - else if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) // Erase flash - { - uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; - - /* Clear the application section of flash */ - while (CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR) - { - boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE; - } - - /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash as writing to the flash locks it out */ - boot_rww_enable(); - - /* Memory has been erased, reset the security bit so that programming/reading is allowed */ - IsSecure = false; - } -} - -/** Handler for a Data Read command issued by the host. This routine handles bootloader information retrieval - * commands such as device signature and bootloader version retrieval. - */ -static void ProcessReadCommand(void) -{ - const uint8_t BootloaderInfo[3] = {BOOTLOADER_VERSION, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2}; - const uint8_t SignatureInfo[4] = {0x58, AVR_SIGNATURE_1, AVR_SIGNATURE_2, AVR_SIGNATURE_3}; - - uint8_t DataIndexToRead = SentCommand.Data[1]; - bool ReadAddressInvalid = false; - - if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read bootloader info - { - if (DataIndexToRead < 3) - ResponseByte = BootloaderInfo[DataIndexToRead]; - else - ReadAddressInvalid = true; - } - else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Read signature byte - { - switch (DataIndexToRead) - { - case 0x30: - ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[0]; - break; - case 0x31: - ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[1]; - break; - case 0x60: - ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[2]; - break; - case 0x61: - ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[3]; - break; - default: - ReadAddressInvalid = true; - break; - } - } - - if (ReadAddressInvalid) - { - /* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */ - DFU_State = dfuERROR; - DFU_Status = errADDRESS; - } -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h deleted file mode 100644 index a97ba6c7ef..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,216 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderDFU.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/wdt.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <avr/pgmspace.h> - #include <avr/eeprom.h> - #include <avr/power.h> - #include <avr/interrupt.h> - #include <util/delay.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include "Descriptors.h" - #include "BootloaderAPI.h" - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> - #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> - - /* Preprocessor Checks: */ - #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) - #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. - #endif - - /* Macros: */ - /** Major bootloader version number. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 2 - - /** Minor bootloader version number. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV 0 - - /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ - #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 - - /** Complete bootloader version number expressed as a packed byte, constructed from the - * two individual bootloader version macros. - */ - #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION ((BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR << 4) | BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV) - - /** First byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1 0xDC - - /** Second byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */ - #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2 0xFB - - /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given one-byte long command. - * - * \param[in] dataarr Command byte array to check against - * \param[in] cb1 First command byte to check - */ - #define IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1) (dataarr[0] == (cb1)) - - /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given two-byte long command. - * - * \param[in] dataarr Command byte array to check against - * \param[in] cb1 First command byte to check - * \param[in] cb2 Second command byte to check - */ - #define IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1, cb2) ((dataarr[0] == (cb1)) && (dataarr[1] == (cb2))) - - /** Length of the DFU file suffix block, appended to the end of each complete memory write command. - * The DFU file suffix is currently unused (but is designed to give extra file information, such as - * a CRC of the complete firmware for error checking) and so is discarded. - */ - #define DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE 16 - - /** Length of the DFU file filler block, appended to the start of each complete memory write command. - * Filler bytes are added to the start of each complete memory write command, and must be discarded. - */ - #define DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE 26 - - /** DFU class command request to detach from the host. */ - #define DFU_REQ_DETATCH 0x00 - - /** DFU class command request to send data from the host to the bootloader. */ - #define DFU_REQ_DNLOAD 0x01 - - /** DFU class command request to send data from the bootloader to the host. */ - #define DFU_REQ_UPLOAD 0x02 - - /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU status and state from the bootloader. */ - #define DFU_REQ_GETSTATUS 0x03 - - /** DFU class command request to reset the current DFU status and state variables to their defaults. */ - #define DFU_REQ_CLRSTATUS 0x04 - - /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU state of the bootloader. */ - #define DFU_REQ_GETSTATE 0x05 - - /** DFU class command request to abort the current multi-request transfer and return to the dfuIDLE state. */ - #define DFU_REQ_ABORT 0x06 - - /** DFU command to begin programming the device's memory. */ - #define COMMAND_PROG_START 0x01 - - /** DFU command to begin reading the device's memory. */ - #define COMMAND_DISP_DATA 0x03 - - /** DFU command to issue a write command. */ - #define COMMAND_WRITE 0x04 - - /** DFU command to issue a read command. */ - #define COMMAND_READ 0x05 - - /** DFU command to issue a memory base address change command, to set the current 64KB flash page - * that subsequent flash operations should use. */ - #define COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR 0x06 - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for a non-returning function pointer to the loaded application. */ - typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN; - - /** Type define for a structure containing a complete DFU command issued by the host. */ - typedef struct - { - uint8_t Command; /**< Single byte command to perform, one of the \c COMMAND_* macro values */ - uint8_t Data[5]; /**< Command parameters */ - uint16_t DataSize; /**< Size of the command parameters */ - } DFU_Command_t; - - /* Enums: */ - /** DFU bootloader states. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each state. */ - enum DFU_State_t - { - appIDLE = 0, - appDETACH = 1, - dfuIDLE = 2, - dfuDNLOAD_SYNC = 3, - dfuDNBUSY = 4, - dfuDNLOAD_IDLE = 5, - dfuMANIFEST_SYNC = 6, - dfuMANIFEST = 7, - dfuMANIFEST_WAIT_RESET = 8, - dfuUPLOAD_IDLE = 9, - dfuERROR = 10 - }; - - /** DFU command status error codes. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each error code. */ - enum DFU_Status_t - { - OK = 0, - errTARGET = 1, - errFILE = 2, - errWRITE = 3, - errERASE = 4, - errCHECK_ERASED = 5, - errPROG = 6, - errVERIFY = 7, - errADDRESS = 8, - errNOTDONE = 9, - errFIRMWARE = 10, - errVENDOR = 11, - errUSBR = 12, - errPOR = 13, - errUNKNOWN = 14, - errSTALLEDPKT = 15 - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - static void SetupHardware(void); - static void ResetHardware(void); - - void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); - - #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C) - static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes); - static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void); - static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void); - static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void); - static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void); - static void ProcessWriteCommand(void); - static void ProcessReadCommand(void); - #endif - - void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt deleted file mode 100644 index b2540a5b6c..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,235 +0,0 @@ -/** \file - * - * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special - * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. - */ - -/** \mainpage DFU Class USB AVR Bootloader - * - * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: - * - * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. - * - * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) - * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) - * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> - * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> - * - * \section Sec_Info USB Information: - * - * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> - * <td>Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> - * <td>Device Firmware Update Class (DFU)</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> - * <td>None</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> - * <td>USBIF DFU Class Standard, Atmel USB Bootloader Datasheet</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> - * <td>Low Speed Mode \n - * Full Speed Mode</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - * - * \section Sec_Description Project Description: - * - * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a DFU Class device, allowing for DFU-compatible programming - * software to load firmware onto the AVR. - * - * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit - * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to - * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. - * - * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the - * bootloader from the normal user application. - * - * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader - * - * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of - * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. - * - * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from - * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the - * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software - * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). - * - * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. - * - * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board - * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the - * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board - * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the - * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation - * - * This bootloader is designed to be compatible with Atmel's provided Windows DFU class drivers. You will need to - * install Atmel's DFU drivers prior to using this bootloader on Windows platforms. If you are using a 64 bit Windows - * OS, you will need to either disable the driver signing requirement (see online tutorials for details) or use a - * digitally signed version of the official Atmel driver provided by a third party AVR user at - * <a>http://www.avrfreaks.net/index.php?module=Freaks%20Academy&func=viewItem&item_id=2196&item_type=project</a>. - * - * \note This device spoofs Atmel's DFU Bootloader USB VID and PID so that the Atmel DFU bootloader - * drivers included with FLIP will work. If you do not wish to use Atmel's ID codes, please - * manually change them in Descriptors.c and alter your driver's INF file accordingly. - * - * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application - * - * This bootloader is compatible with Atmel's FLIP utility on Windows machines, and dfu-programmer on Linux machines. - * - * \subsection SSec_FLIP FLIP (Windows) - * - * FLIP (Flexible In-System Programmer) is a utility written by Atmel, and distributed for free on the Atmel website. - * The FLIP utility is designed to assist in the bootloader programming of a range of Atmel devices, through several - * popular physical interfaces including USB. It is written in Java, however makes use of native extensions for USB - * support and thus is only offered on Windows. - * - * To program a device using FLIP, refer to the Atmel FLIP documentation. - * - * \subsection SSec_DFUProgrammer dfu-programmer (Linux) - * - * dfu-programmer is an open-source command line solution for the bootloader programming of Atmel devices through a - * USB connection, using the DFU protocol, available for download at <a>http://sourceforge.net/projects/dfu-programmer/</a>. - * - * The following example loads a HEX file into the AVR's FLASH memory using dfu-programmer: - * \code - * dfu-programmer at90usb1287 erase flash Mouse.hex - * \endcode - * - * \section Sec_API User Application API - * - * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, - * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. - * - * \warning The APIs exposed by the DFU class bootloader are \b NOT compatible with the API exposed by the official Atmel DFU bootloader. - * - * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the - * following layout: - * - * \code - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) - * - * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_DFU_SIGNATURE 0xDF10 - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 - * \endcode - * - * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address - * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader - * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them - * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_DFU_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH - * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. - * - * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map - * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. - * - * \verbatim - * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | User Application | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE - * | Booloader Start Trampoline | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - (BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE - 4) - * | | - * | Auxillery Bootloader | - * | Space for Smaller Devices | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - * | | - * | Bootloader Application | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 - * | API Table Trampolines | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 - * | Bootloader API Table | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 - * | Bootloader ID Constants | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - * \endverbatim - * - * \subsection SSec_Aux_Space Auxiliary Bootloader Section - * To make the bootloader function on smaller devices (those with a physical - * bootloader section of smaller than 6KB) - * - * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: - * - * \par On Linux machines, the DFU bootloader is inaccessible. - * On many Linux systems, non-root users do not have automatic access to newly - * inserted DFU devices. Root privileges or a UDEV rule is required to gain - * access. - * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. - * - * \section Sec_Options Project Options - * - * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> - * <th><b>Location:</b></th> - * <th><b>Description:</b></th> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>SECURE_MODE</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>If defined to \c true, the bootloader will not accept any memory commands other than a chip erase on start-up, until an - * erase has been performed. This can be used in conjunction with the AVR's lockbits to prevent the AVRs firmware from - * being dumped by unauthorized persons. When false, all memory operations are allowed at any time.</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - */ - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 3acf33c7ea..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief Application Configuration Header File - * - * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of - * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to - * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a - * makefile or build system. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the - * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. - */ - -#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ -#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ - - #define SECURE_MODE false - -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 59ae519e4c..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,93 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File - * - * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, - * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through - * a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA - * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". - */ - -#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ -#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ - - #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) - - /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ -// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES - - /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY -// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH - - /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG - #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) - #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY -// #define USB_HOST_ONLY -// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT - #define NO_SOF_EVENTS - - /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS - #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL - #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 32 - #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 - #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 - #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE -// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT - #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP - #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER - - /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} -// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT -// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE - - #else - - #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. - - #endif -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c deleted file mode 100644 index 46120781b1..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,193 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special - * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine - * the device's capabilities and functions. - */ - -#include "Descriptors.h" -#include "Keyboard.h" - -#ifndef MANUFACTURER - #define MANUFACTURER QMK -#endif -#ifndef PRODUCT - #define PRODUCT Keyboard -#endif - -/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall - * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the - * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration - * process begins. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = -{ - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, - - .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, - .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, - .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, - - .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, - - .VendorID = 0x03EB, - .ProductID = PRODUCT_ID_CODE, - .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,0), - - .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, - .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, - .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS -}; - -/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage - * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces - * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting - * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = -{ - .Config = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, - - .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), - .TotalInterfaces = 1, - - .ConfigurationNumber = 1, - .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, - - .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) - }, - - .DFU_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_DFU, - .AlternateSetting = 0, - - .TotalEndpoints = 0, - - .Class = 0xFE, - .SubClass = 0x01, - .Protocol = 0x02, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .DFU_Functional = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t), .Type = DTYPE_DFUFunctional}, - - .Attributes = (ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD | ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD), - - .DetachTimeout = 0x0000, - .TransferSize = 0x0C00, - - .DFUSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0) - } -}; - -/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests - * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate - * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); - -/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable - * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(LSTR(MANUFACTURER)); - -/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, - * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(LSTR(PRODUCT)); - -/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" - * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given - * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function - * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the - * USB host. - */ -uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) -{ - const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); - const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); - - const void* Address = NULL; - uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; - - switch (DescriptorType) - { - case DTYPE_Device: - Address = &DeviceDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); - break; - case DTYPE_Configuration: - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); - break; - case DTYPE_String: - if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Language) - { - Address = &LanguageString; - Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; - } - else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Manufacturer) - { - Address = &ManufacturerString; - Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; - } - else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Product) - { - Address = &ProductString; - Size = ProductString.Header.Size; - } - - break; - } - - *DescriptorAddress = Address; - return Size; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h deleted file mode 100644 index 7137d0f118..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,200 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for Descriptors.c. - */ - -#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ -#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - /* Macros: */ - /** Descriptor type value for a DFU class functional descriptor. */ - #define DTYPE_DFUFunctional 0x21 - - /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device will detach and re-attach when a DFU_DETACH - * command is issued, rather than the host issuing a USB Reset. - */ - #define ATTR_WILL_DETATCH (1 << 3) - - /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can communicate during the manifestation phase - * (memory programming phase). - */ - #define ATTR_MANEFESTATION_TOLLERANT (1 << 2) - - /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_UPLOAD requests to send data from - * the device to the host. - */ - #define ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD (1 << 1) - - /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_DNLOAD requests to send data from - * the host to the device. - */ - #define ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD (1 << 0) - - #if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF4 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x87 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF3 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x88 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF0 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x8A - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FEF - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFA - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FEE - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 - #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) - #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF7 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 - #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 - #else - #error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader. - #endif - - #if !defined(PRODUCT_ID_CODE) - #error Current AVR model is not supported by this bootloader. - #endif - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for a DFU class function descriptor. This descriptor gives DFU class information - * to the host when read, indicating the DFU device's capabilities. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Standard descriptor header structure */ - - uint8_t Attributes; /**< DFU device attributes, a mask comprising of the - * ATTR_* macros listed in this source file - */ - uint16_t DetachTimeout; /**< Timeout in milliseconds between a USB_DETACH - * command being issued and the device detaching - * from the USB bus - */ - uint16_t TransferSize; /**< Maximum number of bytes the DFU device can accept - * from the host in a transaction - */ - uint16_t DFUSpecification; /**< BCD packed DFU specification number this DFU - * device complies with - */ - } USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t; - - /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the - * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which - * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; - - // DFU Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DFU_Interface; - USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t DFU_Functional; - } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; - - /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor - * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the - * interface from other descriptors. - */ - enum InterfaceDescriptors_t - { - INTERFACE_ID_DFU = 0, /**< DFU interface descriptor ID */ - }; - - /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should - * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from - * other descriptors. - */ - enum StringDescriptors_t - { - STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ - STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ - STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) - ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); - // convert to L string - #define LSTR(s) XLSTR(s) - #define XLSTR(s) L ## #s - // convert to string - #define STR(s) XSTR(s) - #define XSTR(s) #s - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml deleted file mode 100644 index f56aba69f5..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,156 +0,0 @@ -<asf xmlversion="1.0"> - <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_128kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_64kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb647"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_32kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega32u4"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_16kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega16u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_8kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega8u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu" caption="DFU Bootloader"> - <info type="description" value="summary"> - DFU Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device using the Atmel FLIP or other AVR DFU programming software when plugged into a host. - </info> - - <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> - - <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> - <keyword value="Bootloaders"/> - <keyword value="USB Device"/> - </info> - - <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="."/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderDFU.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderDFU.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/> - <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/> - - <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> - - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderDFU.txt"/> - - <require idref="lufa.common"/> - <require idref="lufa.platform"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> - </module> -</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile deleted file mode 100644 index cbb03d6fa9..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2396 +0,0 @@ -# Doxyfile 1.8.9 - -# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system -# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. -# -# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in -# front of the TAG it is preceding. -# -# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. -# The format is: -# TAG = value [value, ...] -# For lists, items can also be appended using: -# TAG += value [value, ...] -# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Project related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file -# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text -# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv -# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv -# for the list of possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by -# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the -# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the -# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. -# The default value is: My Project. - -PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - DFU Class Bootloader" - -# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This -# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version -# control system is used. - -PROJECT_NUMBER = - -# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description -# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a -# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. - -PROJECT_BRIEF = - -# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included -# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 -# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy -# the logo to the output directory. - -PROJECT_LOGO = - -# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path -# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is -# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If -# left blank the current directory will be used. - -OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ - -# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- -# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and -# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this -# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where -# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes -# performance problems for the file system. -# The default value is: NO. - -CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO - -# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII -# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII -# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode -# U+3044. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO - -# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all -# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this -# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. -# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, -# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), -# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, -# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), -# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, -# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, -# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, -# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. -# The default value is: English. - -OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English - -# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member -# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class -# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. -# The default value is: YES. - -BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES - -# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief -# description of a member or function before the detailed description -# -# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the -# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. -# The default value is: YES. - -REPEAT_BRIEF = YES - -# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is -# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found -# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text -# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated -# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the -# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of -# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, -# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. - -ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ - "The $name widget" \ - "The $name file" \ - is \ - provides \ - specifies \ - contains \ - represents \ - a \ - an \ - the - -# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then -# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief -# description. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO - -# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all -# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those -# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment -# operators of the base classes will not be shown. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO - -# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path -# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the -# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used -# The default value is: YES. - -FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES - -# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. -# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand -# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. -# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to -# strip. -# -# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which -# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. -# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. - -STRIP_FROM_PATH = - -# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the -# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which -# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of -# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should -# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler -# using the -I flag. - -STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = - -# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but -# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't -# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHORT_NAMES = YES - -# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the -# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief -# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- -# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief -# description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first -# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If -# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus -# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a -# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as -# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is -# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this -# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. -# -# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are -# not recognized any more. -# The default value is: NO. - -MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO - -# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the -# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. -# The default value is: YES. - -INHERIT_DOCS = YES - -# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new -# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part -# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. -# The default value is: NO. - -SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO - -# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen -# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. - -TAB_SIZE = 4 - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in -# the documentation. An alias has the form: -# name=value -# For example adding -# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" -# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the -# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading -# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert -# newlines. - -ALIASES = - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). -# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" -# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. - -TCL_SUBST = - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources -# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For -# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all -# members will be omitted, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or -# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored -# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, -# qualified scopes will look different, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO - -# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it -# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given -# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it -# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and -# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, -# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: -# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: -# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed -# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For -# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), -# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. -# -# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. -# -# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise -# the files are not read by doxygen. - -EXTENSION_MAPPING = - -# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments -# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable -# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. -# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can -# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in -# case of backward compatibilities issues. -# The default value is: YES. - -MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO - -# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented -# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can -# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or -# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES - -# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want -# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this -# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and -# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); -# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration -# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. -# The default value is: NO. - -BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO - -# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to -# enable parsing support. -# The default value is: NO. - -CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO - -# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: -# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen -# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead -# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. -# The default value is: NO. - -SIP_SUPPORT = NO - -# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate -# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make -# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. -# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple -# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you -# should set this option to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES - -# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC -# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first -# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default -# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. -# The default value is: NO. - -DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO - -# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type -# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that -# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent -# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the -# \nosubgrouping command. -# The default value is: YES. - -SUBGROUPING = YES - -# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions -# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) -# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX -# and RTF). -# -# Note that this feature does not work in combination with -# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO - -# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions -# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in -# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, -# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set -# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and -# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO - -# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or -# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So -# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct -# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, -# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be -# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound -# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. -# The default value is: NO. - -TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO - -# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This -# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be -# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the -# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small -# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The -# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range -# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 -# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest -# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. - -LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Build related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in -# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private -# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the -# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. -# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are -# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ALL = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will -# be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal -# scope will be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO - -# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_STATIC = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined -# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, -# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect -# for Java sources. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES - -# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, -# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are -# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are -# included. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO - -# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be -# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called -# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of -# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace -# are hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these -# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation -# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set -# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option -# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO - -# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend -# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO - -# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any -# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these -# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO - -# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a -# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation -# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INTERNAL_DOCS = NO - -# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file -# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also -# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ -# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows -# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. -# The default value is: system dependent. - -CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with -# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the -# scope will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will -# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to -# YES the compound reference will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO - -# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of -# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES - -# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each -# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader -# which file to include in order to use the member. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO - -# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include -# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. -# The default value is: NO. - -FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO - -# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the -# documentation for inline members. -# The default value is: YES. - -INLINE_INFO = YES - -# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. -# The default value is: YES. - -SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES - -# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief -# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that -# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO - -# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and -# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the -# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. -# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief -# member documentation. -# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting -# detailed member documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO - -# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy -# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will -# appear in their defined order. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO - -# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by -# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will -# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. -# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. -# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical -# list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO - -# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper -# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between -# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is -# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a -# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still -# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. -# The default value is: NO. - -STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO - -# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo -# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test -# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug -# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) -# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in -# the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES - -# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation -# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> -# ... \endcond blocks. - -ENABLED_SECTIONS = - -# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the -# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the -# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here -# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The -# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be -# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the -# documentation regardless of this setting. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. - -MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 - -# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at -# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the -# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_USED_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This -# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View -# (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces -# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the -# Folder Tree View (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES - -# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that -# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from -# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via -# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided -# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file -# version. For an example see the documentation. - -FILE_VERSION_FILTER = - -# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed -# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated -# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file -# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can -# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml -# will be used as the name of the layout file. -# -# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called -# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE -# tag is left empty. - -LAYOUT_FILE = - -# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing -# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib -# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool -# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. -# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using -# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the -# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. - -CITE_BIB_FILES = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to -# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the -# messages are off. -# The default value is: NO. - -QUIET = YES - -# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are -# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES -# this implies that the warnings are on. -# -# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARNINGS = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate -# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag -# will automatically be disabled. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for -# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters -# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using -# markup commands wrongly. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES - -# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that -# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return -# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete -# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES - -# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen -# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which -# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated -# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will -# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) -# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. - -WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" - -# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error -# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard -# error (stderr). - -WARN_LOGFILE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the input files -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain -# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or -# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with -# spaces. -# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. - -INPUT = ./ - -# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files -# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses -# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv -# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of -# possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the -# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, -# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, -# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, -# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, -# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. - -FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ - *.c \ - *.txt - -# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should -# be searched for input files as well. -# The default value is: NO. - -RECURSIVE = YES - -# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be -# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a -# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. -# -# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is -# run. - -EXCLUDE = Documentation/ - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or -# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded -# from the input. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude -# certain files from those directories. -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names -# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the -# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the -# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, -# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ - INCLUDE_FROM_* - -# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include -# command). - -EXAMPLE_PATH = - -# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all -# files are included. - -EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * - -# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be -# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands -# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO - -# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the -# \image command). - -IMAGE_PATH = - -# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should -# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program -# by executing (via popen()) the command: -# -# <filter> <input-file> -# -# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the -# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter -# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag -# will be ignored. -# -# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the -# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added -# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. - -INPUT_FILTER = - -# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern -# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the -# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter -# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how -# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the -# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. - -FILTER_PATTERNS = - -# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using -# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for -# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). -# The default value is: NO. - -FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO - -# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file -# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and -# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using -# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). -# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. - -FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = - -# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that -# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page -# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub -# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. - -USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to source browsing -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be -# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. -# -# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that -# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. -# The default value is: NO. - -SOURCE_BROWSER = NO - -# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, -# classes and enums directly into the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SOURCES = NO - -# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any -# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and -# Fortran comments will always remain visible. -# The default value is: YES. - -STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES - -# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented -# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function -# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCES_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set -# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and -# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will -# link to the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO - -# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the -# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, -# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this -# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you -# can opt to disable this feature. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES - -# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will -# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in -# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system -# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version -# 4.8.6 or higher. -# -# To use it do the following: -# - Install the latest version of global -# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file -# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree -# - Run doxygen as normal -# -# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these -# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). -# -# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to -# source code will now point to the output of htags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -USE_HTAGS = NO - -# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a -# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is -# specified. Set to NO to disable this. -# See also: Section \class. -# The default value is: YES. - -VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO - -# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the -# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the -# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template -# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type -# information. -# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was -# compiled with the --with-libclang option. -# The default value is: NO. - -CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO - -# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command -# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that -# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories -# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. -# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. - -CLANG_OPTIONS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all -# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of -# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. -# The default value is: YES. - -ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES - -# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in -# which the alphabetical index list will be split. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 - -# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will -# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag -# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored -# while generating the index headers. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -IGNORE_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the HTML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_HTML = YES - -# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_OUTPUT = html - -# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each -# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). -# The default value is: .html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html - -# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for -# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a -# standard header. -# -# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets -# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. -# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a -# default header using -# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css -# YourConfigFile -# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" -# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally -# uses. -# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the -# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description -# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_HEADER = - -# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each -# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard -# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default -# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer -# that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FOOTER = - -# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style -# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of -# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style -# sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as -# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become -# obsolete. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets -# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. -# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the -# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. -# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). For an example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note -# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the -# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these -# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the -# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_FILES = - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen -# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to -# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value -# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 -# purple, and 360 is red again. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors -# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A -# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the -# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 -# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output -# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents -# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not -# change the gamma. -# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 - -# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML -# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this -# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO - -# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML -# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the -# page has loaded. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES - -# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries -# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand -# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to -# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless -# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of -# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value -# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded -# tree by default. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 - -# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development -# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with -# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a -# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in -# that directory and running make install will install the docset in -# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at -# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html -# for more information. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_DOCSET = NO - -# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides -# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider -# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. -# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" - -# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation -# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. -# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify -# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style -# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. -# The default value is: Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher - -# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three -# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The -# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop -# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on -# Windows. -# -# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output -# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML -# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old -# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed -# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for -# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for -# compressed HTML files. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO - -# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm -# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be -# written to the html output directory. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_FILE = - -# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path -# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, -# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. -# The file has to be specified with full path. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -HHC_LOCATION = - -# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated -# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -GENERATE_CHI = NO - -# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) -# and project file content. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = - -# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated -# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it -# enables the Previous and Next buttons. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -BINARY_TOC = NO - -# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to -# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -TOC_EXPAND = YES - -# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and -# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that -# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help -# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_QHP = NO - -# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify -# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to -# the HTML output folder. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QCH_FILE = - -# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help -# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace -# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project - -# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt -# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual -# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- -# folders). -# The default value is: doc. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc - -# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom -# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = - -# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the -# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this -# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: -# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's -# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the -# generated .qhp file. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHG_LOCATION = - -# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To -# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in -# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs -# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory -# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. -# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO - -# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin -# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this -# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. - -ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might -# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The -# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top -# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables -# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation -# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -DISABLE_INDEX = YES - -# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index -# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag -# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like -# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this -# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required -# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the -# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can -# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style -# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at -# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has -# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting -# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES - -# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that -# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. -# -# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing -# in the overview section. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 - -# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used -# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 - -# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to -# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO - -# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in -# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful -# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML -# output directory to force them to be regenerated. -# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images -# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not -# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. -# -# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in -# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see -# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering -# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX -# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When -# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path -# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -USE_MATHJAX = NO - -# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for -# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: -# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. -# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best -# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. -# The default value is: HTML-CSS. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS - -# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML -# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory -# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory -# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then -# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax -# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing -# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of -# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. -# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest - -# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax -# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example -# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = - -# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces -# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site -# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an -# example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_CODEFILE = - -# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for -# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and -# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help -# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) -# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. -# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then -# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to -# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S -# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically -# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down -# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated -# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel -# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the -# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> -# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter -# option. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE = NO - -# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be -# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There -# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH -# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and -# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing -# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section -# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO - -# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP -# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file -# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an -# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the -# search results. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). -# -# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO - -# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server -# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and -# Searching" for details. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE_URL = - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed -# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the -# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. -# The default file is: searchdata.xml. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the -# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is -# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple -# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = - -# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen -# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are -# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a -# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of -# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: -# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_LATEX = NO - -# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_OUTPUT = latex - -# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be -# invoked. -# -# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating -# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is -# written to the output directory. -# The default file is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex - -# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate -# index for LaTeX. -# The default file is: makeindex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex - -# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -COMPACT_LATEX = NO - -# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the -# printer. -# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x -# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). -# The default value is: a4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PAPER_TYPE = a4wide - -# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names -# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for -# instance you can specify -# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times -# If left blank no extra packages will be included. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -EXTRA_PACKAGES = - -# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the -# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the -# default header to a separate file. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The -# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, -# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, -# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty -# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred -# to HTML_HEADER. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HEADER = - -# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the -# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See -# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what -# special commands can be used inside the footer. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_FOOTER = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created -# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen -# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output -# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or -# markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = - -# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is -# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will -# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This -# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES - -# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate -# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a -# higher quality PDF documentation. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -USE_PDFLATEX = YES - -# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode -# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running -# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used -# when generating formulas in HTML. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO - -# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the -# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO - -# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source -# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the -# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. -# The default value is: plain. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the RTF output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The -# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF -# readers/editors. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_RTF = NO - -# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: rtf. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_OUTPUT = rtf - -# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -COMPACT_RTF = NO - -# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will -# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML -# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online -# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those -# fields. -# -# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO - -# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config -# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, -# missing definitions are set to their default value. -# -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the -# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = - -# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is -# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated -# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = - -# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code -# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the man page output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for -# classes and files. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_MAN = NO - -# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by -# MAN_OUTPUT. -# The default directory is: man. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_OUTPUT = man - -# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated -# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number -# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is -# optional. -# The default value is: .3. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_EXTENSION = .3 - -# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within -# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by -# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_SUBDIR = - -# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it -# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real -# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without -# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_LINKS = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the XML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that -# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_XML = NO - -# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: xml. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_OUTPUT = xml - -# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program -# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to -# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size -# of the XML output. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files -# that can be used to generate PDF. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO - -# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. -# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in -# front of it. -# The default directory is: docbook. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook - -# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the -# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing -# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly -# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an -# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the -# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is -# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the Perl module output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module -# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# -# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary -# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI -# output from the Perl module output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_LATEX = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely -# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to -# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the -# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it -# just the same. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES - -# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are -# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful -# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't -# overwrite each other's variables. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the preprocessor -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all -# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. -# The default value is: YES. - -ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names -# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be -# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting -# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -MACRO_EXPANSION = YES - -# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then -# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and -# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES - -# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the -# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES - -# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the -# preprocessor. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_PATH = - -# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard -# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the -# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be -# used. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = - -# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are -# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. -# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or -# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" -# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or -# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ - PROGMEM \ - ATTR_NO_INIT - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this -# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The -# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED -# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the -# definition found in the source code. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = - -# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will -# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have -# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros -# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not -# removed. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to external references -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag -# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of -# a tag file without this location is as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... -# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... -# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the -# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use -# of tag files. -# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include -# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is -# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. - -TAGFILES = - -# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a -# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to -# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. - -GENERATE_TAGFILE = - -# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in -# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be -# listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLEXTERNALS = NO - -# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed -# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be -# listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES - -# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in -# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will -# be listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES - -# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script -# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). -# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. - -PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the dot tool -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram -# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to -# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT -# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more -# powerful graphs. -# The default value is: YES. - -CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO - -# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc -# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: -# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the -# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where -# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the -# default search path. - -MSCGEN_PATH = - -# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will -# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The -# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. -# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. - -DIA_PATH = - -# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance -# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. -# The default value is: YES. - -HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES - -# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is -# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: -# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent -# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is -# set to NO -# The default value is: NO. - -HAVE_DOT = NO - -# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed -# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of -# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value -# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing -# speed. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 - -# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen -# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make -# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a -# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by -# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. -# The default value is: Helvetica. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTNAME = - -# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of -# dot graphs. -# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with -# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set -# the path where dot can find it using this tag. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTPATH = - -# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. -# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CLASS_GRAPH = NO - -# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a -# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation -# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the -# class with other documented classes. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GROUP_GRAPHS = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and -# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling -# Language. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LOOK = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the -# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may -# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the -# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 -# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit -# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, -# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to -# 10. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 - -# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and -# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their -# instances. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO - -# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to -# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the -# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO - -# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are -# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing -# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callgraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALL_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callergraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALLER_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical -# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO - -# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the -# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The -# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the -# files in the directories. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO - -# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images -# generated by dot. -# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order -# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this -# requirement). -# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. -# The default value is: png. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png - -# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to -# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. -# -# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested -# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. -# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make -# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO - -# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be -# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_PATH = - -# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile -# command). -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOTFILE_DIRS = - -# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile -# command). - -MSCFILE_DIRS = - -# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile -# command). - -DIAFILE_DIRS = - -# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the -# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed -# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will -# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and -# will not generate output for the diagram. - -PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = - -# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by -# the !include statement in a plantuml block. - -PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = - -# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes -# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes -# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized -# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct -# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that -# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 - -# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs -# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the -# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay -# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 -# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also -# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 - -# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent -# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem -# to support this out of the box. -# -# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to -# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to -# read). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output -# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This -# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support -# this, this feature is disabled by default. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO - -# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page -# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated -# graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GENERATE_LEGEND = YES - -# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot -# files that are used to generate the various graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index a10a576376..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# -# -------------------------------------- -# LUFA Project Makefile. -# -------------------------------------- - -# Run "make help" for target help. - -MCU ?= atmega32u4 -ARCH ?= AVR8 -BOARD ?= QMK -F_CPU ?= 16000000 -F_USB ?= $(F_CPU) -OPTIMIZATION = s -TARGET = BootloaderDFU -SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) -LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA -CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) - -# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must -# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the -# device's fuses. -FLASH_SIZE_KB ?= 32 -BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB ?= 4 - -# Bootloader address calculation formulas -# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. -CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) -BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) -BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) - -# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to -# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. -BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) - -# Default target -all: - -# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules -DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk - -# Include common DMBS build system modules -DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS -include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c deleted file mode 100644 index fa1dd5873e..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,198 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Main source file for the HID class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. - */ - -#include "BootloaderHID.h" - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run - * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application - * started via a forced watchdog reset. - */ -static bool RunBootloader = true; - -/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader - * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held - * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value - * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. - */ -uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; - - -/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application - * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, - * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. - */ -void Application_Jump_Check(void) -{ - /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ - if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - { - /* Turn off the watchdog */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ - MagicBootKey = 0; - - // cppcheck-suppress constStatement - ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); - } -} - -/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously - * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit. - */ -int main(void) -{ - /* Setup hardware required for the bootloader */ - SetupHardware(); - - /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ - GlobalInterruptEnable(); - - while (RunBootloader) - USB_USBTask(); - - /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ - USB_Detach(); - - /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ - MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; - - /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ - wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); - - for (;;); -} - -/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ -static void SetupHardware(void) -{ - /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Disable clock division */ - clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); - - /* Initialize USB subsystem */ - USB_Init(); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready - * to relay data to and from the attached USB host. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) -{ - /* Setup HID Report Endpoint */ - Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(HID_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, HID_IN_EPSIZE, 1); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to - * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing - * internally. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) -{ - /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the HID interface */ - if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != - (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) - { - return; - } - - /* Process HID specific control requests */ - switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) - { - case HID_REQ_SetReport: - Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); - - /* Wait until the command has been sent by the host */ - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())); - - /* Read in the write destination address */ - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - uint32_t PageAddress = ((uint32_t)Endpoint_Read_16_LE() << 8); - #else - uint16_t PageAddress = Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); - #endif - - /* Check if the command is a program page command, or a start application command */ - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - if ((uint16_t)(PageAddress >> 8) == COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION) - #else - if (PageAddress == COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION) - #endif - { - RunBootloader = false; - } - else if (PageAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR) - { - /* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */ - boot_page_erase(PageAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - /* Write each of the FLASH page's bytes in sequence */ - for (uint8_t PageWord = 0; PageWord < (SPM_PAGESIZE / 2); PageWord++) - { - /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ - if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) - { - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())); - } - - /* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */ - boot_page_fill(PageAddress + ((uint16_t)PageWord << 1), Endpoint_Read_16_LE()); - } - - /* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */ - boot_page_write(PageAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - /* Re-enable RWW section */ - boot_rww_enable(); - } - - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); - break; - } -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h deleted file mode 100644 index 62ee07de30..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,71 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderHID.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADERHID_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADERHID_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/wdt.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <avr/power.h> - #include <avr/interrupt.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include "Descriptors.h" - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> - - /* Preprocessor Checks: */ - #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) - #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. - #endif - - /* Macros: */ - /** Bootloader special address to start the user application */ - #define COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION 0xFFFF - - /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ - #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - static void SetupHardware(void); - - void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); - - void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); - -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt deleted file mode 100644 index e340703c41..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,105 +0,0 @@ -/** \file - * - * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special - * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. - */ - -/** \mainpage HID Class USB AVR Bootloader - * - * \section SSec_Compat Demo Compatibility: - * - * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. - * - * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) - * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) - * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - * - * \section SSec_Info USB Information: - * - * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> - * <td>Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> - * <td>Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> - * <td>N/A</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> - * <td>USBIF HID Class Standard \n - * Teensy Programming Protocol Specification</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> - * <td>Low Speed Mode \n - * Full Speed Mode</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - * - * \section SSec_Description Project Description: - * - * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a HID Class device, allowing for device FLASH programming through - * the supplied command line software, which is a modified version of Paul's TeensyHID Command Line loader code - * from PJRC (used with permission). This bootloader is deliberately non-compatible with the proprietary PJRC - * HalfKay bootloader GUI; only the command line interface software accompanying this bootloader will work with it. - * - * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit - * into 2KB of bootloader space for the Series 2 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU2, AT90USBxx2) or 4KB of bootloader space for - * all other models. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the MCU, - * FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. - * - * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device - * lockbits are set. - * - * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader - * - * This bootloader is designed to be started via the \c HWB mechanism of the USB AVRs; ground the \c HWB pin (see device - * datasheet) then momentarily ground \c /RESET to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is set and the - * \c BOOTRST fuse is cleared. - * - * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation - * - * This bootloader uses the HID class driver inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no additional drivers - * need to be supplied for correct operation. - * - * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application - * - * Due to licensing issues, the supplied bootloader is compatible with the HalfKay bootloader protocol designed - * by PJRC, but is <b>not compatible with the cross-platform loader GUI</b>. A modified version of the open source - * cross-platform TeensyLoader application is supplied, which can be compiled under most operating systems. The - * command-line loader application should remain compatible with genuine Teensy boards in addition to boards using - * this custom bootloader. - * - * Once compiled, programs can be loaded into the AVR's FLASH memory through the following example command: - * \code - * hid_bootloader_cli -mmcu=at90usb1287 Mouse.hex - * \endcode - * - * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: - * - * \par After loading an application, it is not run automatically on startup. - * Some USB AVR boards ship with the \c BOOTRST fuse set, causing the bootloader - * to run automatically when the device is reset. This booloader requires the - * \c BOOTRST be disabled and the HWBE fuse used instead to run the bootloader - * when needed. - * - * \section SSec_Options Project Options - * - * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td> - * None - * </td> - * </tr> - * </table> - */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5aa0e765bf..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,93 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File - * - * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, - * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through - * a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA - * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". - */ - -#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ -#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ - - #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) - - /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ -// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES - - /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY -// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH - - /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG - #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) - #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY -// #define USB_HOST_ONLY -// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT - #define NO_SOF_EVENTS - - /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS - #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL - #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 - #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 - #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 -// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE -// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT - #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP - #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER - - /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} -// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT -// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE - - #else - - #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. - - #endif -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c deleted file mode 100644 index 854ae1b636..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,187 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special - * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine - * the device's capabilities and functions. - */ - -#include "Descriptors.h" - -/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the - * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This - * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) - * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for - * more details on HID report descriptors. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t HIDReport[] = -{ - HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(16, 0xFFDC), /* Vendor Page 0xDC */ - HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xFB), /* Vendor Usage 0xFB */ - HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Vendor Usage 1 */ - HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Vendor Usage 2 */ - HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), - HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), - HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), - HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(16, (sizeof(uint16_t) + SPM_PAGESIZE)), - HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), - HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), -}; - -/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall - * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the - * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration - * process begins. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = -{ - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, - - .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, - .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, - .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, - - .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, - - .VendorID = 0x03EB, - .ProductID = 0x2067, - .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), - - .ManufacturerStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - .ProductStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS -}; - -/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage - * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces - * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting - * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = -{ - .Config = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, - - .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), - .TotalInterfaces = 1, - - .ConfigurationNumber = 1, - .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, - - .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) - }, - - .HID_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID, - .AlternateSetting = 0x00, - - .TotalEndpoints = 1, - - .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, - .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, - .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .HID_VendorHID = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, - - .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), - .CountryCode = 0x00, - .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, - .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, - .HIDReportLength = sizeof(HIDReport) - }, - - .HID_ReportINEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = HID_IN_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = HID_IN_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - }, -}; - -/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" - * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given - * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function - * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the - * USB host. - */ -uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) -{ - const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); - - const void* Address = NULL; - uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; - - /* If/Else If chain compiles slightly smaller than a switch case */ - if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Device) - { - Address = &DeviceDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); - } - else if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Configuration) - { - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); - } - else if (DescriptorType == HID_DTYPE_HID) - { - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_VendorHID; - Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); - } - else if (DescriptorType == HID_DTYPE_Report) - { - Address = &HIDReport; - Size = sizeof(HIDReport); - } - - *DescriptorAddress = Address; - return Size; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5516b16354..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,80 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for Descriptors.c. - */ - -#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ -#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the - * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which - * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; - - // Generic HID Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; - USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_VendorHID; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; - } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; - - /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor - * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the - * interface from other descriptors. - */ - enum InterfaceDescriptors_t - { - INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID = 0, /**< GenericHID interface descriptor ID */ - }; - - /* Macros: */ - /** Endpoint address of the HID data IN endpoint. */ - #define HID_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) - - /** Size in bytes of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */ - #define HID_IN_EPSIZE 64 - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) - ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore deleted file mode 100644 index 4e73d1ec5b..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore +++ /dev/null @@ -1 +0,0 @@ -hid_bootloader_cli diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile deleted file mode 100644 index d7d6458a5c..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -OS ?= LINUX -#OS ?= WINDOWS -#OS ?= MACOSX -#OS ?= BSD - -ifeq ($(OS), LINUX) # also works on FreeBSD -CC ?= gcc -CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall -hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c - $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_LIBUSB -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c -lusb - - -else ifeq ($(OS), WINDOWS) -CC = i586-mingw32msvc-gcc -CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall -LDLIB = -lsetupapi -lhid -hid_bootloader_cli.exe: hid_bootloader_cli.c - $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_WIN32 -o hid_bootloader_cli.exe hid_bootloader_cli.c $(LDLIB) - - -else ifeq ($(OS), MACOSX) -CC ?= gcc -SDK ?= /Developer/SDKs/MacOSX10.5.sdk -CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall -hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c - $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -DUSE_APPLE_IOKIT -isysroot $(SDK) -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c -Wl,-syslibroot,$(SDK) -framework IOKit -framework CoreFoundation - - -else ifeq ($(OS), BSD) # works on NetBSD and OpenBSD -CC ?= gcct -CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall -hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c - $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_UHID -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c - - -endif - - -clean: - rm -f hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd deleted file mode 100644 index a15a664053..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd +++ /dev/null @@ -1,21 +0,0 @@ -OS ?= FreeBSD -#OS ?= NetBSD -#OS ?= OpenBSD - -CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall -CC ?= gcc - -.if $(OS) == "FreeBSD" -CFLAGS += -DUSE_LIBUSB -LIBS = -lusb -.elif $(OS) == "NetBSD" || $(OS) == "OpenBSD" -CFLAGS += -DUSE_UHID -LIBS = -.endif - - -hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c - $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c $(LIBS) - -clean: - rm -f hid_bootloader_cli diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 94a9ed024d..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,674 +0,0 @@ - GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE - Version 3, 29 June 2007 - - Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> - Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies - of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. - - Preamble - - The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for -software and other kinds of works. - - The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed -to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, -the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to -share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free -software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the -GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to -any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to -your programs, too. - - When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not -price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you -have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for -them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you -want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new -free programs, and that you know you can do these things. - - To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you -these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have -certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if -you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. - - For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether -gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same -freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive -or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they -know their rights. - - Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: -(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License -giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. - - For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains -that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and -authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as -changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to -authors of previous versions. - - Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run -modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer -can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of -protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic -pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to -use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we -have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those -products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we -stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions -of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. - - Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. -States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of -software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to -avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could -make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that -patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. - - The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and -modification follow. - - TERMS AND CONDITIONS - - 0. Definitions. - - "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. - - "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of -works, such as semiconductor masks. - - "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this -License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and -"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. - - To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work -in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an -exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the -earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. - - A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based -on the Program. - - To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without -permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for -infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a -computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, -distribution (with or without modification), making available to the -public, and in some countries other activities as well. - - To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other -parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through -a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. - - An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" -to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible -feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) -tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the -extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the -work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If -the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a -menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. - - 1. Source Code. - - The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work -for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source -form of a work. - - A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official -standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of -interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that -is widely used among developers working in that language. - - The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other -than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of -packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major -Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that -Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an -implementation is available to the public in source code form. A -"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component -(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system -(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to -produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. - - The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all -the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable -work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to -control those activities. However, it does not include the work's -System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free -programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but -which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source -includes interface definition files associated with source files for -the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically -linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, -such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those -subprograms and other parts of the work. - - The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users -can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding -Source. - - The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that -same work. - - 2. Basic Permissions. - - All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of -copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated -conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited -permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a -covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its -content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your -rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. - - You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not -convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains -in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose -of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you -with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with -the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do -not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works -for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction -and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of -your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. - - Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under -the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 -makes it unnecessary. - - 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. - - No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological -measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article -11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or -similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such -measures. - - When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid -circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention -is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to -the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or -modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's -users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of -technological measures. - - 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. - - You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you -receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and -appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; -keep intact all notices stating that this License and any -non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; -keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all -recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. - - You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, -and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. - - 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. - - You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to -produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the -terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: - - a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified - it, and giving a relevant date. - - b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is - released under this License and any conditions added under section - 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to - "keep intact all notices". - - c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this - License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This - License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 - additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, - regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no - permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not - invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. - - d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display - Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive - interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your - work need not make them do so. - - A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent -works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, -and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, -in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an -"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not -used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users -beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work -in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other -parts of the aggregate. - - 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. - - You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms -of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the -machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, -in one of these ways: - - a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product - (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the - Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium - customarily used for software interchange. - - b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product - (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a - written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as - long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product - model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a - copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the - product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical - medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no - more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this - conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the - Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. - - c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the - written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This - alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and - only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord - with subsection 6b. - - d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated - place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the - Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no - further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the - Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to - copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source - may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) - that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain - clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the - Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the - Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is - available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. - - e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided - you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding - Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no - charge under subsection 6d. - - A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded -from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be -included in conveying the object code work. - - A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any -tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, -or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation -into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, -doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular -product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a -typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status -of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user -actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product -is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial -commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent -the only significant mode of use of the product. - - "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, -procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install -and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from -a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must -suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object -code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because -modification has been made. - - If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or -specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as -part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the -User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a -fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the -Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied -by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply -if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install -modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has -been installed in ROM). - - The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a -requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates -for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for -the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a -network may be denied when the modification itself materially and -adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and -protocols for communication across the network. - - Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, -in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly -documented (and with an implementation available to the public in -source code form), and must require no special password or key for -unpacking, reading or copying. - - 7. Additional Terms. - - "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this -License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. -Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall -be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent -that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions -apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately -under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by -this License without regard to the additional permissions. - - When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option -remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of -it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own -removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place -additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, -for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. - - Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you -add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of -that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: - - a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the - terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or - - b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or - author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal - Notices displayed by works containing it; or - - c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or - requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in - reasonable ways as different from the original version; or - - d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or - authors of the material; or - - e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some - trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or - - f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that - material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of - it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for - any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on - those licensors and authors. - - All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further -restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you -received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is -governed by this License along with a term that is a further -restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains -a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this -License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms -of that license document, provided that the further restriction does -not survive such relicensing or conveying. - - If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you -must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the -additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating -where to find the applicable terms. - - Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the -form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; -the above requirements apply either way. - - 8. Termination. - - You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly -provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or -modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under -this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third -paragraph of section 11). - - However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your -license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) -provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and -finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright -holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means -prior to 60 days after the cessation. - - Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is -reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the -violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have -received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that -copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after -your receipt of the notice. - - Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the -licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under -this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently -reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same -material under section 10. - - 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. - - You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or -run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work -occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission -to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, -nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or -modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do -not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a -covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. - - 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. - - Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically -receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and -propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible -for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. - - An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an -organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an -organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered -work results from an entity transaction, each party to that -transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever -licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could -give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the -Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if -the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. - - You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the -rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may -not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of -rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation -(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that -any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for -sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. - - 11. Patents. - - A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this -License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The -work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". - - A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims -owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or -hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted -by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, -but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a -consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For -purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant -patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of -this License. - - Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free -patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to -make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and -propagate the contents of its contributor version. - - In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express -agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent -(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to -sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a -party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a -patent against the party. - - If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, -and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone -to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a -publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, -then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so -available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the -patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner -consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent -license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have -actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the -covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work -in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that -country that you have reason to believe are valid. - - If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or -arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a -covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties -receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify -or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license -you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered -work and works based on it. - - A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within -the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is -conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are -specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered -work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is -in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment -to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying -the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the -parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory -patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work -conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily -for and in connection with specific products or compilations that -contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, -or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. - - Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting -any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may -otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. - - 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. - - If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or -otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not -excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a -covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this -License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may -not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you -to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey -the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this -License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. - - 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. - - Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have -permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed -under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single -combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this -License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, -but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, -section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the -combination as such. - - 14. Revised Versions of this License. - - The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of -the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will -be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to -address new problems or concerns. - - Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the -Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General -Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the -option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered -version or of any later version published by the Free Software -Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the -GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published -by the Free Software Foundation. - - If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future -versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's -public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you -to choose that version for the Program. - - Later license versions may give you additional or different -permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any -author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a -later version. - - 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. - - THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY -APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT -HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY -OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, -THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR -PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM -IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF -ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. - - 16. Limitation of Liability. - - IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING -WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS -THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY -GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE -USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF -DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD -PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), -EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -SUCH DAMAGES. - - 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. - - If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided -above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, -reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates -an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the -Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a -copy of the Program in return for a fee. - - END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS - - How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs - - If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest -possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it -free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. - - To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest -to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively -state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least -the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. - - <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> - Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> - - This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify - it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by - the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or - (at your option) any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the - GNU General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License - along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. - -Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. - - If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short -notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: - - <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> - This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. - This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it - under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. - -The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate -parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands -might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". - - You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, -if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. -For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see -<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. - - The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program -into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you -may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with -the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General -Public License instead of this License. But first, please read -<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c deleted file mode 100644 index b54f943b1c..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1013 +0,0 @@ -/* Modified for the LUFA HID Bootloader by Dean Camera - * http://www.lufa-lib.org - * - * THIS MODIFIED VERSION IS UNSUPPORTED BY PJRC. - */ - -/* Teensy Loader, Command Line Interface - * Program and Reboot Teensy Board with HalfKay Bootloader - * http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/loader_cli.html - * Copyright 2008-2010, PJRC.COM, LLC - * - * - * You may redistribute this program and/or modify it under the terms - * of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software - * Foundation, version 3 of the License. - * - * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the - * GNU General Public License for more details. - * - * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License - * along with this program. If not, see http://www.gnu.org/licenses/ - */ - -/* Want to incorporate this code into a proprietary application?? - * Just email paul@pjrc.com to ask. Usually it's not a problem, - * but you do need to ask to use this code in any way other than - * those permitted by the GNU General Public License, version 3 */ - -/* For non-root permissions on ubuntu or similar udev-based linux - * http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/49-teensy.rules - */ - -#include <stdio.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <stdint.h> -#include <stdarg.h> -#include <string.h> -#include <unistd.h> - -void usage(void) -{ - fprintf(stderr, "Usage: hid_bootloader_cli -mmcu=<MCU> [-w] [-h] [-n] [-v] <file.hex>\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "\t-w : Wait for device to appear\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "\t-r : Use hard reboot if device not online\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "\t-n : No reboot after programming\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "\t-v : Verbose output\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "\n<MCU> = atmegaXXuY or at90usbXXXY"); - - fprintf(stderr, "\nFor support and more information, please visit:\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "http://www.lufa-lib.org\n"); - - fprintf(stderr, "\nBased on the TeensyHID command line programmer software:\n"); - fprintf(stderr, "http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/loader_cli.html\n"); - exit(1); -} - -// USB Access Functions -int teensy_open(void); -int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout); -void teensy_close(void); -int hard_reboot(void); - -// Intel Hex File Functions -int read_intel_hex(const char *filename); -int ihex_bytes_within_range(int begin, int end); -void ihex_get_data(int addr, int len, unsigned char *bytes); - -// Misc stuff -int printf_verbose(const char *format, ...); -void delay(double seconds); -void die(const char *str, ...); -void parse_options(int argc, char **argv); - -// options (from user via command line args) -int wait_for_device_to_appear = 0; -int hard_reboot_device = 0; -int reboot_after_programming = 1; -int verbose = 0; -int code_size = 0, block_size = 0; -const char *filename=NULL; - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* Main Program */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -int main(int argc, char **argv) -{ - unsigned char buf[260]; - int num, addr, r, first_block=1, waited=0; - - // parse command line arguments - parse_options(argc, argv); - if (!filename) { - fprintf(stderr, "Filename must be specified\n\n"); - usage(); - } - if (!code_size) { - fprintf(stderr, "MCU type must be specified\n\n"); - usage(); - } - printf_verbose("Teensy Loader, Command Line, Version 2.0\n"); - - // read the intel hex file - // this is done first so any error is reported before using USB - num = read_intel_hex(filename); - if (num < 0) die("error reading intel hex file \"%s\"", filename); - printf_verbose("Read \"%s\": %d bytes, %.1f%% usage\n", - filename, num, (double)num / (double)code_size * 100.0); - - // open the USB device - while (1) { - if (teensy_open()) break; - if (hard_reboot_device) { - if (!hard_reboot()) die("Unable to find rebootor\n"); - printf_verbose("Hard Reboot performed\n"); - hard_reboot_device = 0; // only hard reboot once - wait_for_device_to_appear = 1; - } - if (!wait_for_device_to_appear) die("Unable to open device\n"); - if (!waited) { - printf_verbose("Waiting for Teensy device...\n"); - printf_verbose(" (hint: press the reset button)\n"); - waited = 1; - } - delay(0.25); - } - printf_verbose("Found HalfKay Bootloader\n"); - - // if we waited for the device, read the hex file again - // perhaps it changed while we were waiting? - if (waited) { - num = read_intel_hex(filename); - if (num < 0) die("error reading intel hex file \"%s\"", filename); - printf_verbose("Read \"%s\": %d bytes, %.1f%% usage\n", - filename, num, (double)num / (double)code_size * 100.0); - } - - // program the data - printf_verbose("Programming"); - fflush(stdout); - for (addr = 0; addr < code_size; addr += block_size) { - if (addr > 0 && !ihex_bytes_within_range(addr, addr + block_size - 1)) { - // don't waste time on blocks that are unused, - // but always do the first one to erase the chip - continue; - } - printf_verbose("."); - if (code_size < 0x10000) { - buf[0] = addr & 255; - buf[1] = (addr >> 8) & 255; - } else { - buf[0] = (addr >> 8) & 255; - buf[1] = (addr >> 16) & 255; - } - ihex_get_data(addr, block_size, buf + 2); - r = teensy_write(buf, block_size + 2, first_block ? 3.0 : 0.25); - if (!r) die("error writing to Teensy\n"); - first_block = 0; - } - printf_verbose("\n"); - - // reboot to the user's new code - if (reboot_after_programming) { - printf_verbose("Booting\n"); - buf[0] = 0xFF; - buf[1] = 0xFF; - memset(buf + 2, 0, sizeof(buf) - 2); - teensy_write(buf, block_size + 2, 0.25); - } - teensy_close(); - return 0; -} - - - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* USB Access - libusb (Linux & FreeBSD) */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -#if defined(USE_LIBUSB) - -// http://libusb.sourceforge.net/doc/index.html -#include <usb.h> - -usb_dev_handle * open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) -{ - struct usb_bus *bus; - struct usb_device *dev; - usb_dev_handle *h; - #ifdef LIBUSB_HAS_GET_DRIVER_NP - char buf[128]; - #endif - int r; - - usb_init(); - usb_find_busses(); - usb_find_devices(); - //printf_verbose("\nSearching for USB device:\n"); - for (bus = usb_get_busses(); bus; bus = bus->next) { - for (dev = bus->devices; dev; dev = dev->next) { - //printf_verbose("bus \"%s\", device \"%s\" vid=%04X, pid=%04X\n", - // bus->dirname, dev->filename, - // dev->descriptor.idVendor, - // dev->descriptor.idProduct - //); - if (dev->descriptor.idVendor != vid) continue; - if (dev->descriptor.idProduct != pid) continue; - h = usb_open(dev); - if (!h) { - printf_verbose("Found device but unable to open"); - continue; - } - #ifdef LIBUSB_HAS_GET_DRIVER_NP - r = usb_get_driver_np(h, 0, buf, sizeof(buf)); - if (r >= 0) { - r = usb_detach_kernel_driver_np(h, 0); - if (r < 0) { - usb_close(h); - printf_verbose("Device is in use by \"%s\" driver", buf); - continue; - } - } - #endif - // Mac OS-X - removing this call to usb_claim_interface() might allow - // this to work, even though it is a clear misuse of the libusb API. - // normally Apple's IOKit should be used on Mac OS-X - r = usb_claim_interface(h, 0); - if (r < 0) { - usb_close(h); - printf_verbose("Unable to claim interface, check USB permissions"); - continue; - } - return h; - } - } - return NULL; -} - -static usb_dev_handle *libusb_teensy_handle = NULL; - -int teensy_open(void) -{ - teensy_close(); - libusb_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); - - if (!libusb_teensy_handle) - libusb_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return 0; - return 1; -} - -int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) -{ - int r; - - if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return 0; - r = usb_control_msg(libusb_teensy_handle, 0x21, 9, 0x0200, 0, (char *)buf, - len, (int)(timeout * 1000.0)); - if (r < 0) return 0; - return 1; -} - -void teensy_close(void) -{ - if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return; - usb_release_interface(libusb_teensy_handle, 0); - usb_close(libusb_teensy_handle); - libusb_teensy_handle = NULL; -} - -int hard_reboot(void) -{ - usb_dev_handle *rebootor; - int r; - - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); - - if (!rebootor) - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!rebootor) return 0; - r = usb_control_msg(rebootor, 0x21, 9, 0x0200, 0, "reboot", 6, 100); - usb_release_interface(rebootor, 0); - usb_close(rebootor); - if (r < 0) return 0; - return 1; -} - -#endif - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* USB Access - Microsoft WIN32 */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -#if defined(USE_WIN32) - -// http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ms790932.aspx -#include <windows.h> -#include <setupapi.h> -#include <ddk/hidsdi.h> -#include <ddk/hidclass.h> - -HANDLE open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) -{ - GUID guid; - HDEVINFO info; - DWORD index, required_size; - SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DATA iface; - SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA *details; - HIDD_ATTRIBUTES attrib; - HANDLE h; - BOOL ret; - - HidD_GetHidGuid(&guid); - info = SetupDiGetClassDevs(&guid, NULL, NULL, DIGCF_PRESENT | DIGCF_DEVICEINTERFACE); - if (info == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) return NULL; - for (index=0; 1 ;index++) { - iface.cbSize = sizeof(SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DATA); - ret = SetupDiEnumDeviceInterfaces(info, NULL, &guid, index, &iface); - if (!ret) { - SetupDiDestroyDeviceInfoList(info); - break; - } - SetupDiGetInterfaceDeviceDetail(info, &iface, NULL, 0, &required_size, NULL); - details = (SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA *)malloc(required_size); - if (details == NULL) continue; - memset(details, 0, required_size); - details->cbSize = sizeof(SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA); - ret = SetupDiGetDeviceInterfaceDetail(info, &iface, details, - required_size, NULL, NULL); - if (!ret) { - free(details); - continue; - } - h = CreateFile(details->DevicePath, GENERIC_READ|GENERIC_WRITE, - FILE_SHARE_READ|FILE_SHARE_WRITE, NULL, OPEN_EXISTING, - FILE_FLAG_OVERLAPPED, NULL); - free(details); - if (h == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) continue; - attrib.Size = sizeof(HIDD_ATTRIBUTES); - ret = HidD_GetAttributes(h, &attrib); - if (!ret) { - CloseHandle(h); - continue; - } - if (attrib.VendorID != vid || attrib.ProductID != pid) { - CloseHandle(h); - continue; - } - SetupDiDestroyDeviceInfoList(info); - return h; - } - return NULL; -} - -int write_usb_device(HANDLE h, void *buf, int len, int timeout) -{ - static HANDLE event = NULL; - unsigned char tmpbuf[1040]; - OVERLAPPED ov; - DWORD n, r; - - if (len > sizeof(tmpbuf) - 1) return 0; - if (event == NULL) { - event = CreateEvent(NULL, TRUE, TRUE, NULL); - if (!event) return 0; - } - ResetEvent(&event); - memset(&ov, 0, sizeof(ov)); - ov.hEvent = event; - tmpbuf[0] = 0; - memcpy(tmpbuf + 1, buf, len); - if (!WriteFile(h, tmpbuf, len + 1, NULL, &ov)) { - if (GetLastError() != ERROR_IO_PENDING) return 0; - r = WaitForSingleObject(event, timeout); - if (r == WAIT_TIMEOUT) { - CancelIo(h); - return 0; - } - if (r != WAIT_OBJECT_0) return 0; - } - if (!GetOverlappedResult(h, &ov, &n, FALSE)) return 0; - return 1; -} - -static HANDLE win32_teensy_handle = NULL; - -int teensy_open(void) -{ - teensy_close(); - win32_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); - - if (!win32_teensy_handle) - win32_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!win32_teensy_handle) return 0; - return 1; -} - -int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) -{ - int r; - if (!win32_teensy_handle) return 0; - r = write_usb_device(win32_teensy_handle, buf, len, (int)(timeout * 1000.0)); - return r; -} - -void teensy_close(void) -{ - if (!win32_teensy_handle) return; - CloseHandle(win32_teensy_handle); - win32_teensy_handle = NULL; -} - -int hard_reboot(void) -{ - HANDLE rebootor; - int r; - - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); - - if (!rebootor) - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!rebootor) return 0; - r = write_usb_device(rebootor, "reboot", 6, 100); - CloseHandle(rebootor); - return r; -} - -#endif - - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* USB Access - Apple's IOKit, Mac OS-X */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -#if defined(USE_APPLE_IOKIT) - -// http://developer.apple.com/technotes/tn2007/tn2187.html -#include <IOKit/IOKitLib.h> -#include <IOKit/hid/IOHIDLib.h> -#include <IOKit/hid/IOHIDDevice.h> - -struct usb_list_struct { - IOHIDDeviceRef ref; - int pid; - int vid; - struct usb_list_struct *next; -}; - -static struct usb_list_struct *usb_list=NULL; -static IOHIDManagerRef hid_manager=NULL; - -void attach_callback(void *context, IOReturn r, void *hid_mgr, IOHIDDeviceRef dev) -{ - CFTypeRef type; - struct usb_list_struct *n, *p; - int32_t pid, vid; - - if (!dev) return; - type = IOHIDDeviceGetProperty(dev, CFSTR(kIOHIDVendorIDKey)); - if (!type || CFGetTypeID(type) != CFNumberGetTypeID()) return; - if (!CFNumberGetValue((CFNumberRef)type, kCFNumberSInt32Type, &vid)) return; - type = IOHIDDeviceGetProperty(dev, CFSTR(kIOHIDProductIDKey)); - if (!type || CFGetTypeID(type) != CFNumberGetTypeID()) return; - if (!CFNumberGetValue((CFNumberRef)type, kCFNumberSInt32Type, &pid)) return; - n = (struct usb_list_struct *)malloc(sizeof(struct usb_list_struct)); - if (!n) return; - //printf("attach callback: vid=%04X, pid=%04X\n", vid, pid); - n->ref = dev; - n->vid = vid; - n->pid = pid; - n->next = NULL; - if (usb_list == NULL) { - usb_list = n; - } else { - for (p = usb_list; p->next; p = p->next) ; - p->next = n; - } -} - -void detach_callback(void *context, IOReturn r, void *hid_mgr, IOHIDDeviceRef dev) -{ - struct usb_list_struct *p, *tmp, *prev=NULL; - - p = usb_list; - while (p) { - if (p->ref == dev) { - if (prev) { - prev->next = p->next; - } else { - usb_list = p->next; - } - tmp = p; - p = p->next; - free(tmp); - } else { - prev = p; - p = p->next; - } - } -} - -void init_hid_manager(void) -{ - CFMutableDictionaryRef dict; - IOReturn ret; - - if (hid_manager) return; - hid_manager = IOHIDManagerCreate(kCFAllocatorDefault, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); - if (hid_manager == NULL || CFGetTypeID(hid_manager) != IOHIDManagerGetTypeID()) { - if (hid_manager) CFRelease(hid_manager); - printf_verbose("no HID Manager - maybe this is a pre-Leopard (10.5) system?\n"); - return; - } - dict = CFDictionaryCreateMutable(kCFAllocatorDefault, 0, - &kCFTypeDictionaryKeyCallBacks, &kCFTypeDictionaryValueCallBacks); - if (!dict) return; - IOHIDManagerSetDeviceMatching(hid_manager, dict); - CFRelease(dict); - IOHIDManagerScheduleWithRunLoop(hid_manager, CFRunLoopGetCurrent(), kCFRunLoopDefaultMode); - IOHIDManagerRegisterDeviceMatchingCallback(hid_manager, attach_callback, NULL); - IOHIDManagerRegisterDeviceRemovalCallback(hid_manager, detach_callback, NULL); - ret = IOHIDManagerOpen(hid_manager, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); - if (ret != kIOReturnSuccess) { - IOHIDManagerUnscheduleFromRunLoop(hid_manager, - CFRunLoopGetCurrent(), kCFRunLoopDefaultMode); - CFRelease(hid_manager); - printf_verbose("Error opening HID Manager"); - } -} - -static void do_run_loop(void) -{ - while (CFRunLoopRunInMode(kCFRunLoopDefaultMode, 0, true) == kCFRunLoopRunHandledSource) ; -} - -IOHIDDeviceRef open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) -{ - struct usb_list_struct *p; - IOReturn ret; - - init_hid_manager(); - do_run_loop(); - for (p = usb_list; p; p = p->next) { - if (p->vid == vid && p->pid == pid) { - ret = IOHIDDeviceOpen(p->ref, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); - if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return p->ref; - } - } - return NULL; -} - -void close_usb_device(IOHIDDeviceRef dev) -{ - struct usb_list_struct *p; - - do_run_loop(); - for (p = usb_list; p; p = p->next) { - if (p->ref == dev) { - IOHIDDeviceClose(dev, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); - return; - } - } -} - -static IOHIDDeviceRef iokit_teensy_reference = NULL; - -int teensy_open(void) -{ - teensy_close(); - iokit_teensy_reference = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); - - if (!iokit_teensy_reference) - iokit_teensy_reference = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return 0; - return 1; -} - -int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) -{ - IOReturn ret; - - // timeouts do not work on OS-X - // IOHIDDeviceSetReportWithCallback is not implemented - // even though Apple documents it with a code example! - // submitted to Apple on 22-sep-2009, problem ID 7245050 - if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return 0; - ret = IOHIDDeviceSetReport(iokit_teensy_reference, - kIOHIDReportTypeOutput, 0, buf, len); - if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return 1; - return 0; -} - -void teensy_close(void) -{ - if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return; - close_usb_device(iokit_teensy_reference); - iokit_teensy_reference = NULL; -} - -int hard_reboot(void) -{ - IOHIDDeviceRef rebootor; - IOReturn ret; - - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); - - if (!rebootor) - rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (!rebootor) return 0; - ret = IOHIDDeviceSetReport(rebootor, - kIOHIDReportTypeOutput, 0, (uint8_t *)("reboot"), 6); - close_usb_device(rebootor); - if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return 1; - return 0; -} - -#endif - - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* USB Access - BSD's UHID driver */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -#if defined(USE_UHID) - -// Thanks to Todd T Fries for help getting this working on OpenBSD -// and to Chris Kuethe for the initial patch to use UHID. - -#include <sys/ioctl.h> -#include <fcntl.h> -#include <dirent.h> -#include <dev/usb/usb.h> -#ifndef USB_GET_DEVICEINFO -#include <dev/usb/usb_ioctl.h> -#endif - -#ifndef USB_GET_DEVICEINFO -# define USB_GET_DEVICEINFO 0 -# error The USB_GET_DEVICEINFO ioctl() value is not defined for your system. -#endif - -int open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) -{ - int r, fd; - DIR *dir; - struct dirent *d; - struct usb_device_info info; - char buf[256]; - - dir = opendir("/dev"); - if (!dir) return -1; - while ((d = readdir(dir)) != NULL) { - if (strncmp(d->d_name, "uhid", 4) != 0) continue; - snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "/dev/%s", d->d_name); - fd = open(buf, O_RDWR); - if (fd < 0) continue; - r = ioctl(fd, USB_GET_DEVICEINFO, &info); - if (r < 0) { - // NetBSD: added in 2004 - // OpenBSD: added November 23, 2009 - // FreeBSD: missing (FreeBSD 8.0) - USE_LIBUSB works! - die("Error: your uhid driver does not support" - " USB_GET_DEVICEINFO, please upgrade!\n"); - close(fd); - closedir(dir); - exit(1); - } - //printf("%s: v=%d, p=%d\n", buf, info.udi_vendorNo, info.udi_productNo); - if (info.udi_vendorNo == vid && info.udi_productNo == pid) { - closedir(dir); - return fd; - } - close(fd); - } - closedir(dir); - return -1; -} - -static int uhid_teensy_fd = -1; - -int teensy_open(void) -{ - teensy_close(); - uhid_teensy_fd = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); - - if (uhid_teensy_fd < 0) - uhid_teensy_fd = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (uhid_teensy_fd < 0) return 0; - return 1; -} - -int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) -{ - int r; - - // TODO: implement timeout... how?? - r = write(uhid_teensy_fd, buf, len); - if (r == len) return 1; - return 0; -} - -void teensy_close(void) -{ - if (uhid_teensy_fd >= 0) { - close(uhid_teensy_fd); - uhid_teensy_fd = -1; - } -} - -int hard_reboot(void) -{ - int r, rebootor_fd; - - rebootor_fd = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); - - if (rebootor_fd < 0) - rebootor_fd = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); - - if (rebootor_fd < 0) return 0; - r = write(rebootor_fd, "reboot", 6); - delay(0.1); - close(rebootor_fd); - if (r == 6) return 1; - return 0; -} - -#endif - - - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* Read Intel Hex File */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -// the maximum flash image size we can support -// chips with larger memory may be used, but only this -// much intel-hex data can be loaded into memory! -#define MAX_MEMORY_SIZE 0x10000 - -static unsigned char firmware_image[MAX_MEMORY_SIZE]; -static unsigned char firmware_mask[MAX_MEMORY_SIZE]; -static int end_record_seen=0; -static int byte_count; -static unsigned int extended_addr = 0; -static int parse_hex_line(char *line); - -int read_intel_hex(const char *filename) -{ - FILE *fp; - int i, lineno=0; - char buf[1024]; - - byte_count = 0; - end_record_seen = 0; - for (i=0; i<MAX_MEMORY_SIZE; i++) { - firmware_image[i] = 0xFF; - firmware_mask[i] = 0; - } - extended_addr = 0; - - fp = fopen(filename, "r"); - if (fp == NULL) { - //printf("Unable to read file %s\n", filename); - return -1; - } - while (!feof(fp)) { - *buf = '\0'; - if (!fgets(buf, sizeof(buf), fp)) break; - lineno++; - if (*buf) { - if (parse_hex_line(buf) == 0) { - //printf("Warning, parse error line %d\n", lineno); - fclose(fp); - return -2; - } - } - if (end_record_seen) break; - if (feof(stdin)) break; - } - fclose(fp); - return byte_count; -} - - -/* from ihex.c, at http://www.pjrc.com/tech/8051/pm2_docs/intel-hex.html */ - -/* parses a line of intel hex code, stores the data in bytes[] */ -/* and the beginning address in addr, and returns a 1 if the */ -/* line was valid, or a 0 if an error occurred. The variable */ -/* num gets the number of bytes that were stored into bytes[] */ - - -int -parse_hex_line(char *line) -{ - int addr, code, num; - int sum, len, cksum, i; - char *ptr; - - num = 0; - if (line[0] != ':') return 0; - if (strlen(line) < 11) return 0; - ptr = line+1; - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &len)) return 0; - ptr += 2; - if ((int)strlen(line) < (11 + (len * 2)) ) return 0; - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &addr)) return 0; - ptr += 4; - /* printf("Line: length=%d Addr=%d\n", len, addr); */ - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &code)) return 0; - if (addr + extended_addr + len >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) return 0; - ptr += 2; - sum = (len & 255) + ((addr >> 8) & 255) + (addr & 255) + (code & 255); - if (code != 0) { - if (code == 1) { - end_record_seen = 1; - return 1; - } - if (code == 2 && len == 2) { - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &i)) return 1; - ptr += 4; - sum += ((i >> 8) & 255) + (i & 255); - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 1; - if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 1; - extended_addr = i << 4; - //printf("ext addr = %05X\n", extended_addr); - } - if (code == 4 && len == 2) { - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &i)) return 1; - ptr += 4; - sum += ((i >> 8) & 255) + (i & 255); - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 1; - if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 1; - extended_addr = i << 16; - //printf("ext addr = %08X\n", extended_addr); - } - return 1; // non-data line - } - byte_count += len; - while (num != len) { - if (sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &i) != 1) return 0; - i &= 255; - firmware_image[addr + extended_addr + num] = i; - firmware_mask[addr + extended_addr + num] = 1; - ptr += 2; - sum += i; - (num)++; - if (num >= 256) return 0; - } - if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 0; - if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 0; /* checksum error */ - return 1; -} - -int ihex_bytes_within_range(int begin, int end) -{ - int i; - - if (begin < 0 || begin >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE || - end < 0 || end >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) { - return 0; - } - for (i=begin; i<=end; i++) { - if (firmware_mask[i]) return 1; - } - return 0; -} - -void ihex_get_data(int addr, int len, unsigned char *bytes) -{ - int i; - - if (addr < 0 || len < 0 || addr + len >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) { - for (i=0; i<len; i++) { - bytes[i] = 255; - } - return; - } - for (i=0; i<len; i++) { - if (firmware_mask[addr]) { - bytes[i] = firmware_image[addr]; - } else { - bytes[i] = 255; - } - addr++; - } -} - -/****************************************************************/ -/* */ -/* Misc Functions */ -/* */ -/****************************************************************/ - -int printf_verbose(const char *format, ...) -{ - va_list ap; - int r = 0; - - va_start(ap, format); - if (verbose) { - r = vprintf(format, ap); - fflush(stdout); - } - va_end(ap); - - return r; -} - -void delay(double seconds) -{ - #ifdef USE_WIN32 - sleep(seconds * 1000.0); - #else - usleep(seconds * 1000000.0); - #endif -} - -void die(const char *str, ...) -{ - va_list ap; - - va_start(ap, str); - vfprintf(stderr, str, ap); - fprintf(stderr, "\n"); - va_end(ap); - - exit(1); -} - -#if defined USE_WIN32 -#define strcasecmp stricmp -#endif - -void parse_options(int argc, char **argv) -{ - int i; - const char *arg; - - for (i=1; i<argc; i++) { - arg = argv[i]; - - if (*arg == '-') { - if (strcmp(arg, "-w") == 0) { - wait_for_device_to_appear = 1; - } else if (strcmp(arg, "-r") == 0) { - hard_reboot_device = 1; - } else if (strcmp(arg, "-n") == 0) { - reboot_after_programming = 0; - } else if (strcmp(arg, "-v") == 0) { - verbose = 1; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "-mmcu=", 6) == 0) { - arg += 6; - - if (strncmp(arg, "at90usb", 7) == 0) { - arg += 7; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "atmega", 6) == 0) { - arg += 6; - } else { - die("Unknown MCU type\n"); - } - - if (strncmp(arg, "128", 3) == 0) { - code_size = 128 * 1024; - block_size = 256; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "64", 2) == 0) { - code_size = 64 * 1024; - block_size = 256; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "32", 2) == 0) { - code_size = 32 * 1024; - block_size = 128; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "16", 2) == 0) { - code_size = 16 * 1024; - block_size = 128; - } else if (strncmp(arg, "8", 1) == 0) { - code_size = 8 * 1024; - block_size = 128; - } else { - die("Unknown MCU type\n"); - } - } - } else { - filename = argv[i]; - } - } -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py deleted file mode 100644 index cb824f5822..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py +++ /dev/null @@ -1,120 +0,0 @@ -""" - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -""" - -""" - Front-end programmer for the LUFA HID class bootloader. - - Usage: - python hid_bootloader_loader.py <Device> <Input>.hex - - Example: - python hid_bootloader_loader.py at90usb1287 Mouse.hex - - Requires the pywinusb (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/pywinusb/) and - IntelHex (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/IntelHex/) libraries. -""" - -import sys -from pywinusb import hid -from intelhex import IntelHex - - -# Device information table -device_info_map = dict() -device_info_map['at90usb1287'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 128} -device_info_map['at90usb1286'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 128} -device_info_map['at90usb647'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 64} -device_info_map['at90usb646'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 64} -device_info_map['atmega32u4'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 32} -device_info_map['atmega32u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 32} -device_info_map['atmega16u4'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} -device_info_map['atmega16u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} -device_info_map['at90usb162'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} -device_info_map['atmega8u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 8} -device_info_map['at90usb82'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 8} - - -def get_hid_device_handle(): - hid_device_filter = hid.HidDeviceFilter(vendor_id=0x03EB, - product_id=0x2067) - - valid_hid_devices = hid_device_filter.get_devices() - - if len(valid_hid_devices) is 0: - return None - else: - return valid_hid_devices[0] - - -def send_page_data(hid_device, address, data): - # Bootloader page data should be the HID Report ID (always zero) followed - # by the starting address to program, then one device's flash page worth - # of data - output_report_data = [0] - output_report_data.extend([address & 0xFF, address >> 8]) - output_report_data.extend(data) - - hid_device.send_output_report(output_report_data) - - -def program_device(hex_data, device_info): - hid_device = get_hid_device_handle() - - if hid_device is None: - print("No valid HID device found.") - sys.exit(1) - - try: - hid_device.open() - print("Connected to bootloader.") - - # Program in all data from the loaded HEX file, in a number of device - # page sized chunks - for addr in range(0, hex_data.maxaddr(), device_info['page_size']): - # Compute the address range of the current page in the device - current_page_range = range(addr, addr+device_info['page_size']) - - # Extract the data from the hex file at the specified start page - # address and convert it to a regular list of bytes - page_data = [hex_data[i] for i in current_page_range] - - print("Writing address 0x%04X-0x%04X" % (current_page_range[0], current_page_range[-1])) - - # Devices with more than 64KB of flash should shift down the page - # address so that it is 16-bit (page size is guaranteed to be - # >= 256 bytes so no non-zero address bits are discarded) - if device_info['flash_kb'] < 64: - send_page_data(hid_device, addr, page_data) - else: - send_page_data(hid_device, addr >> 8, page_data) - - # Once programming is complete, start the application via a dummy page - # program to the page address 0xFFFF - print("Programming complete, starting application.") - send_page_data(hid_device, 0xFFFF, [0] * device_info['page_size']) - - finally: - hid_device.close() - - -if __name__ == '__main__': - # Load the specified HEX file - try: - hex_data = IntelHex(sys.argv[2]) - except: - print("Could not open the specified HEX file.") - sys.exit(1) - - # Retrieve the device information entry for the specified device - try: - device_info = device_info_map[sys.argv[1]] - except: - print("Unknown device name specified.") - sys.exit(1) - - program_device(hex_data, device_info) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml deleted file mode 100644 index c67b9419ed..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,123 +0,0 @@ -<asf xmlversion="1.0"> - <project caption="HID Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_128kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/> - </project> - - <project caption="HID Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_64kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb647"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/> - </project> - - <project caption="HID Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_32kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega32u4"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/> - </project> - - <project caption="HID Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 2KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.16_2" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_16kb_2kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega16u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3800"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3800"/> - </project> - - <project caption="HID Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 2KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.8_2" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_8kb_2kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega8u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1800"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1800"/> - </project> - - <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid" caption="HID Bootloader"> - <info type="description" value="summary"> - HID Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device via a custom cross-platform command line utility when plugged into a host. - </info> - - <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> - - <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> - <keyword value="Bootloaders"/> - <keyword value="USB Device"/> - </info> - - <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="."/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderHID.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderHID.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> - - <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> - - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderHID.txt"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostLoaderApp"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostLoaderApp_Python"/> - - <require idref="lufa.common"/> - <require idref="lufa.platform"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> - </module> -</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile deleted file mode 100644 index 4c3de5ab98..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2398 +0,0 @@ -# Doxyfile 1.8.9 - -# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system -# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. -# -# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in -# front of the TAG it is preceding. -# -# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. -# The format is: -# TAG = value [value, ...] -# For lists, items can also be appended using: -# TAG += value [value, ...] -# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Project related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file -# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text -# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv -# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv -# for the list of possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by -# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the -# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the -# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. -# The default value is: My Project. - -PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - HID Class Bootloader" - -# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This -# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version -# control system is used. - -PROJECT_NUMBER = - -# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description -# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a -# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. - -PROJECT_BRIEF = - -# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included -# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 -# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy -# the logo to the output directory. - -PROJECT_LOGO = - -# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path -# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is -# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If -# left blank the current directory will be used. - -OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ - -# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- -# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and -# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this -# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where -# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes -# performance problems for the file system. -# The default value is: NO. - -CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO - -# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII -# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII -# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode -# U+3044. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO - -# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all -# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this -# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. -# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, -# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), -# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, -# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), -# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, -# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, -# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, -# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. -# The default value is: English. - -OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English - -# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member -# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class -# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. -# The default value is: YES. - -BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES - -# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief -# description of a member or function before the detailed description -# -# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the -# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. -# The default value is: YES. - -REPEAT_BRIEF = YES - -# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is -# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found -# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text -# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated -# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the -# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of -# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, -# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. - -ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ - "The $name widget" \ - "The $name file" \ - is \ - provides \ - specifies \ - contains \ - represents \ - a \ - an \ - the - -# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then -# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief -# description. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO - -# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all -# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those -# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment -# operators of the base classes will not be shown. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO - -# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path -# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the -# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used -# The default value is: YES. - -FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES - -# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. -# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand -# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. -# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to -# strip. -# -# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which -# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. -# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. - -STRIP_FROM_PATH = - -# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the -# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which -# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of -# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should -# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler -# using the -I flag. - -STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = - -# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but -# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't -# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHORT_NAMES = YES - -# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the -# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief -# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- -# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief -# description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first -# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If -# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus -# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a -# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as -# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is -# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this -# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. -# -# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are -# not recognized any more. -# The default value is: NO. - -MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO - -# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the -# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. -# The default value is: YES. - -INHERIT_DOCS = YES - -# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new -# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part -# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. -# The default value is: NO. - -SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO - -# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen -# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. - -TAB_SIZE = 4 - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in -# the documentation. An alias has the form: -# name=value -# For example adding -# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" -# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the -# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading -# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert -# newlines. - -ALIASES = - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). -# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" -# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. - -TCL_SUBST = - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources -# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For -# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all -# members will be omitted, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or -# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored -# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, -# qualified scopes will look different, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO - -# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it -# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given -# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it -# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and -# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, -# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: -# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: -# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed -# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For -# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), -# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. -# -# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. -# -# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise -# the files are not read by doxygen. - -EXTENSION_MAPPING = - -# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments -# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable -# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. -# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can -# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in -# case of backward compatibilities issues. -# The default value is: YES. - -MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO - -# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented -# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can -# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or -# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES - -# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want -# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this -# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and -# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); -# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration -# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. -# The default value is: NO. - -BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO - -# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to -# enable parsing support. -# The default value is: NO. - -CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO - -# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: -# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen -# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead -# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. -# The default value is: NO. - -SIP_SUPPORT = NO - -# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate -# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make -# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. -# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple -# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you -# should set this option to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES - -# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC -# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first -# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default -# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. -# The default value is: NO. - -DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO - -# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type -# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that -# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent -# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the -# \nosubgrouping command. -# The default value is: YES. - -SUBGROUPING = YES - -# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions -# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) -# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX -# and RTF). -# -# Note that this feature does not work in combination with -# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO - -# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions -# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in -# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, -# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set -# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and -# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO - -# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or -# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So -# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct -# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, -# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be -# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound -# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. -# The default value is: NO. - -TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO - -# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This -# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be -# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the -# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small -# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The -# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range -# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 -# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest -# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. - -LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Build related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in -# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private -# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the -# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. -# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are -# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ALL = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will -# be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal -# scope will be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO - -# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_STATIC = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined -# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, -# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect -# for Java sources. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES - -# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, -# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are -# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are -# included. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO - -# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be -# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called -# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of -# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace -# are hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these -# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation -# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set -# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option -# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO - -# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend -# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO - -# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any -# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these -# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO - -# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a -# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation -# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INTERNAL_DOCS = NO - -# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file -# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also -# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ -# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows -# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. -# The default value is: system dependent. - -CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with -# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the -# scope will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will -# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to -# YES the compound reference will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO - -# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of -# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES - -# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each -# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader -# which file to include in order to use the member. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO - -# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include -# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. -# The default value is: NO. - -FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO - -# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the -# documentation for inline members. -# The default value is: YES. - -INLINE_INFO = YES - -# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. -# The default value is: YES. - -SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES - -# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief -# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that -# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO - -# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and -# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the -# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. -# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief -# member documentation. -# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting -# detailed member documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO - -# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy -# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will -# appear in their defined order. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO - -# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by -# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will -# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. -# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. -# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical -# list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO - -# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper -# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between -# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is -# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a -# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still -# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. -# The default value is: NO. - -STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO - -# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo -# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test -# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug -# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) -# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in -# the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES - -# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation -# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> -# ... \endcond blocks. - -ENABLED_SECTIONS = - -# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the -# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the -# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here -# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The -# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be -# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the -# documentation regardless of this setting. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. - -MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 - -# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at -# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the -# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_USED_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This -# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View -# (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces -# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the -# Folder Tree View (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES - -# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that -# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from -# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via -# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided -# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file -# version. For an example see the documentation. - -FILE_VERSION_FILTER = - -# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed -# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated -# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file -# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can -# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml -# will be used as the name of the layout file. -# -# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called -# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE -# tag is left empty. - -LAYOUT_FILE = - -# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing -# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib -# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool -# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. -# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using -# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the -# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. - -CITE_BIB_FILES = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to -# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the -# messages are off. -# The default value is: NO. - -QUIET = YES - -# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are -# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES -# this implies that the warnings are on. -# -# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARNINGS = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate -# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag -# will automatically be disabled. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for -# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters -# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using -# markup commands wrongly. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES - -# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that -# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return -# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete -# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES - -# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen -# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which -# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated -# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will -# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) -# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. - -WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" - -# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error -# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard -# error (stderr). - -WARN_LOGFILE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the input files -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain -# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or -# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with -# spaces. -# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. - -INPUT = ./ - -# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files -# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses -# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv -# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of -# possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the -# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, -# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, -# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, -# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, -# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. - -FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ - *.c \ - *.txt - -# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should -# be searched for input files as well. -# The default value is: NO. - -RECURSIVE = YES - -# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be -# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a -# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. -# -# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is -# run. - -EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ - HostLoaderApp/ \ - HostLoaderApp_Python/ - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or -# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded -# from the input. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude -# certain files from those directories. -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names -# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the -# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the -# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, -# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ - INCLUDE_FROM_* - -# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include -# command). - -EXAMPLE_PATH = - -# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all -# files are included. - -EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * - -# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be -# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands -# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO - -# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the -# \image command). - -IMAGE_PATH = - -# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should -# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program -# by executing (via popen()) the command: -# -# <filter> <input-file> -# -# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the -# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter -# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag -# will be ignored. -# -# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the -# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added -# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. - -INPUT_FILTER = - -# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern -# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the -# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter -# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how -# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the -# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. - -FILTER_PATTERNS = - -# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using -# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for -# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). -# The default value is: NO. - -FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO - -# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file -# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and -# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using -# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). -# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. - -FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = - -# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that -# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page -# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub -# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. - -USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to source browsing -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be -# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. -# -# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that -# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. -# The default value is: NO. - -SOURCE_BROWSER = NO - -# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, -# classes and enums directly into the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SOURCES = NO - -# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any -# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and -# Fortran comments will always remain visible. -# The default value is: YES. - -STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES - -# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented -# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function -# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCES_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set -# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and -# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will -# link to the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO - -# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the -# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, -# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this -# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you -# can opt to disable this feature. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES - -# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will -# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in -# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system -# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version -# 4.8.6 or higher. -# -# To use it do the following: -# - Install the latest version of global -# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file -# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree -# - Run doxygen as normal -# -# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these -# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). -# -# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to -# source code will now point to the output of htags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -USE_HTAGS = NO - -# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a -# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is -# specified. Set to NO to disable this. -# See also: Section \class. -# The default value is: YES. - -VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO - -# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the -# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the -# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template -# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type -# information. -# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was -# compiled with the --with-libclang option. -# The default value is: NO. - -CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO - -# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command -# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that -# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories -# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. -# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. - -CLANG_OPTIONS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all -# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of -# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. -# The default value is: YES. - -ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES - -# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in -# which the alphabetical index list will be split. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 - -# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will -# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag -# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored -# while generating the index headers. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -IGNORE_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the HTML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_HTML = YES - -# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_OUTPUT = html - -# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each -# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). -# The default value is: .html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html - -# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for -# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a -# standard header. -# -# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets -# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. -# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a -# default header using -# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css -# YourConfigFile -# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" -# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally -# uses. -# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the -# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description -# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_HEADER = - -# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each -# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard -# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default -# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer -# that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FOOTER = - -# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style -# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of -# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style -# sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as -# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become -# obsolete. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets -# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. -# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the -# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. -# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). For an example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note -# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the -# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these -# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the -# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_FILES = - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen -# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to -# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value -# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 -# purple, and 360 is red again. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors -# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A -# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the -# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 -# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output -# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents -# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not -# change the gamma. -# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 - -# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML -# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this -# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO - -# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML -# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the -# page has loaded. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES - -# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries -# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand -# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to -# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless -# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of -# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value -# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded -# tree by default. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 - -# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development -# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with -# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a -# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in -# that directory and running make install will install the docset in -# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at -# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html -# for more information. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_DOCSET = NO - -# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides -# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider -# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. -# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" - -# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation -# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. -# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify -# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style -# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. -# The default value is: Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher - -# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three -# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The -# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop -# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on -# Windows. -# -# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output -# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML -# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old -# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed -# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for -# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for -# compressed HTML files. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO - -# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm -# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be -# written to the html output directory. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_FILE = - -# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path -# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, -# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. -# The file has to be specified with full path. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -HHC_LOCATION = - -# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated -# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -GENERATE_CHI = NO - -# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) -# and project file content. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = - -# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated -# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it -# enables the Previous and Next buttons. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -BINARY_TOC = NO - -# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to -# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -TOC_EXPAND = YES - -# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and -# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that -# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help -# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_QHP = NO - -# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify -# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to -# the HTML output folder. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QCH_FILE = - -# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help -# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace -# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project - -# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt -# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual -# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- -# folders). -# The default value is: doc. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc - -# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom -# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = - -# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the -# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this -# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: -# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's -# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the -# generated .qhp file. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHG_LOCATION = - -# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To -# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in -# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs -# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory -# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. -# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO - -# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin -# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this -# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. - -ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might -# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The -# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top -# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables -# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation -# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -DISABLE_INDEX = YES - -# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index -# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag -# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like -# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this -# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required -# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the -# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can -# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style -# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at -# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has -# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting -# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES - -# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that -# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. -# -# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing -# in the overview section. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 - -# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used -# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 - -# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to -# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO - -# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in -# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful -# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML -# output directory to force them to be regenerated. -# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images -# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not -# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. -# -# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in -# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see -# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering -# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX -# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When -# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path -# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -USE_MATHJAX = NO - -# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for -# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: -# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. -# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best -# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. -# The default value is: HTML-CSS. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS - -# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML -# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory -# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory -# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then -# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax -# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing -# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of -# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. -# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest - -# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax -# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example -# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = - -# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces -# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site -# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an -# example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_CODEFILE = - -# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for -# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and -# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help -# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) -# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. -# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then -# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to -# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S -# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically -# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down -# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated -# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel -# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the -# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> -# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter -# option. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE = NO - -# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be -# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There -# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH -# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and -# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing -# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section -# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO - -# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP -# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file -# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an -# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the -# search results. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). -# -# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO - -# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server -# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and -# Searching" for details. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE_URL = - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed -# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the -# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. -# The default file is: searchdata.xml. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the -# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is -# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple -# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = - -# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen -# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are -# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a -# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of -# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: -# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_LATEX = NO - -# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_OUTPUT = latex - -# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be -# invoked. -# -# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating -# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is -# written to the output directory. -# The default file is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex - -# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate -# index for LaTeX. -# The default file is: makeindex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex - -# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -COMPACT_LATEX = NO - -# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the -# printer. -# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x -# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). -# The default value is: a4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PAPER_TYPE = a4wide - -# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names -# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for -# instance you can specify -# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times -# If left blank no extra packages will be included. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -EXTRA_PACKAGES = - -# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the -# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the -# default header to a separate file. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The -# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, -# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, -# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty -# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred -# to HTML_HEADER. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HEADER = - -# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the -# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See -# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what -# special commands can be used inside the footer. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_FOOTER = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created -# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen -# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output -# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or -# markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = - -# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is -# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will -# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This -# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES - -# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate -# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a -# higher quality PDF documentation. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -USE_PDFLATEX = YES - -# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode -# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running -# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used -# when generating formulas in HTML. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO - -# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the -# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO - -# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source -# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the -# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. -# The default value is: plain. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the RTF output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The -# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF -# readers/editors. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_RTF = NO - -# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: rtf. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_OUTPUT = rtf - -# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -COMPACT_RTF = NO - -# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will -# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML -# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online -# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those -# fields. -# -# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO - -# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config -# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, -# missing definitions are set to their default value. -# -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the -# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = - -# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is -# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated -# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = - -# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code -# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the man page output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for -# classes and files. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_MAN = NO - -# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by -# MAN_OUTPUT. -# The default directory is: man. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_OUTPUT = man - -# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated -# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number -# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is -# optional. -# The default value is: .3. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_EXTENSION = .3 - -# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within -# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by -# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_SUBDIR = - -# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it -# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real -# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without -# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_LINKS = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the XML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that -# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_XML = NO - -# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: xml. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_OUTPUT = xml - -# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program -# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to -# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size -# of the XML output. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files -# that can be used to generate PDF. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO - -# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. -# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in -# front of it. -# The default directory is: docbook. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook - -# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the -# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing -# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly -# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an -# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the -# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is -# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the Perl module output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module -# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# -# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary -# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI -# output from the Perl module output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_LATEX = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely -# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to -# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the -# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it -# just the same. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES - -# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are -# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful -# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't -# overwrite each other's variables. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the preprocessor -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all -# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. -# The default value is: YES. - -ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names -# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be -# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting -# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -MACRO_EXPANSION = YES - -# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then -# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and -# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES - -# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the -# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES - -# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the -# preprocessor. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_PATH = - -# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard -# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the -# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be -# used. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = - -# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are -# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. -# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or -# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" -# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or -# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ - PROGMEM \ - ATTR_NO_INIT - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this -# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The -# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED -# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the -# definition found in the source code. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = - -# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will -# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have -# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros -# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not -# removed. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to external references -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag -# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of -# a tag file without this location is as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... -# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... -# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the -# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use -# of tag files. -# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include -# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is -# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. - -TAGFILES = - -# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a -# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to -# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. - -GENERATE_TAGFILE = - -# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in -# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be -# listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLEXTERNALS = NO - -# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed -# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be -# listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES - -# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in -# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will -# be listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES - -# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script -# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). -# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. - -PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the dot tool -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram -# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to -# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT -# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more -# powerful graphs. -# The default value is: YES. - -CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO - -# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc -# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: -# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the -# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where -# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the -# default search path. - -MSCGEN_PATH = - -# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will -# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The -# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. -# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. - -DIA_PATH = - -# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance -# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. -# The default value is: YES. - -HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES - -# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is -# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: -# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent -# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is -# set to NO -# The default value is: NO. - -HAVE_DOT = NO - -# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed -# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of -# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value -# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing -# speed. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 - -# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen -# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make -# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a -# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by -# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. -# The default value is: Helvetica. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTNAME = - -# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of -# dot graphs. -# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with -# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set -# the path where dot can find it using this tag. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTPATH = - -# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. -# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CLASS_GRAPH = NO - -# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a -# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation -# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the -# class with other documented classes. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GROUP_GRAPHS = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and -# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling -# Language. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LOOK = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the -# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may -# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the -# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 -# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit -# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, -# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to -# 10. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 - -# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and -# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their -# instances. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO - -# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to -# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the -# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO - -# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are -# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing -# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callgraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALL_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callergraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALLER_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical -# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO - -# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the -# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The -# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the -# files in the directories. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO - -# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images -# generated by dot. -# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order -# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this -# requirement). -# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. -# The default value is: png. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png - -# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to -# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. -# -# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested -# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. -# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make -# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO - -# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be -# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_PATH = - -# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile -# command). -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOTFILE_DIRS = - -# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile -# command). - -MSCFILE_DIRS = - -# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile -# command). - -DIAFILE_DIRS = - -# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the -# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed -# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will -# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and -# will not generate output for the diagram. - -PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = - -# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by -# the !include statement in a plantuml block. - -PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = - -# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes -# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes -# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized -# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct -# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that -# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 - -# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs -# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the -# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay -# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 -# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also -# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 - -# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent -# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem -# to support this out of the box. -# -# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to -# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to -# read). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output -# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This -# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support -# this, this feature is disabled by default. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO - -# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page -# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated -# graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GENERATE_LEGEND = YES - -# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot -# files that are used to generate the various graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index 12cfadb5d4..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,55 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# -# -------------------------------------- -# LUFA Project Makefile. -# -------------------------------------- - -# Run "make help" for target help. - -MCU = at90usb1287 -ARCH = AVR8 -BOARD = USBKEY -F_CPU = 8000000 -F_USB = $(F_CPU) -OPTIMIZATION = s -TARGET = BootloaderHID -SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) -LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA -CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -IConfig/ -LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) - -# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must -# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the -# device's fuses. -FLASH_SIZE_KB := 128 -BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB := 8 - -# Bootloader address calculation formulas -# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. -CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) -BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) -BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) - -# Default target -all: - -# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules -DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk - -# Include common DMBS build system modules -DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS -include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c deleted file mode 100644 index 491c506d0f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,76 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Bootloader user application API functions. - */ - -#include "BootloaderAPI.h" - -void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_erase_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_write_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) -{ - boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) -{ - boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4889b4c0db..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,63 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> - - /* Macros: */ - #if AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE > 0 - #define AUX_BOOT_SECTION __attribute__((section(".boot_aux"))) - #else - #define AUX_BOOT_SECTION - #endif - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); - void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S deleted file mode 100644 index 44eb15ea9d..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S +++ /dev/null @@ -1,102 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -#if AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE > 0 -#warning Using a AUX bootloader section in addition to the defined bootloader space (see documentation). - -; Trampoline to jump over the AUX bootloader section to the start of the bootloader, -; on devices where an AUX bootloader section is used. -.section .boot_aux_trampoline, "ax" -.global Boot_AUX_Trampoline -Boot_AUX_Trampoline: - jmp BOOT_START_ADDR -#endif - -; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the -; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) -.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines -BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: - - BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage - BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage - BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord - BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature - BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse - BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock - BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: - ret - - - -; API function jump table -.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable -BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: - - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 - - - -; Bootloader table signatures and information -.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures -BootloaderAPI_Signatures: - - .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader - .word 0xDF30 ; Signature for the MS class bootloader, V1 - .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6c9697b660..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,263 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Main source file for the Mass Storage class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. - */ - -#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_MASSSTORAGE_C -#include "BootloaderMassStorage.h" - -/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is - * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class - * within a device can be differentiated from one another. - */ -USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = - { - .Config = - { - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, - .DataINEndpoint = - { - .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, - .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, - .Banks = 1, - }, - .DataOUTEndpoint = - { - .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, - .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, - .Banks = 1, - }, - .TotalLUNs = 1, - }, - }; - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run - * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application - * started via a forced watchdog reset. - */ -bool RunBootloader = true; - -/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader - * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held - * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value - * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. - */ -uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; - -/** Indicates if the bootloader is allowed to exit immediately if \ref RunBootloader is \c false. During shutdown all - * pending commands must be processed before jumping to the user-application, thus this tracks the main program loop - * iterations since a SCSI command from the host was received. - */ -static uint8_t TicksSinceLastCommand = 0; - - -/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application - * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, - * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. - */ -void Application_Jump_Check(void) -{ - bool JumpToApplication = false; - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) - /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTC |= (1 << 7); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); - - /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ - PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); - #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) - /* Disable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_DISABLE(); - - /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTF |= (1 << 4); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); - - /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_ENABLE(); - #else - /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ - if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) - { - /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ - if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); - } - else - { - /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; - * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ - if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - } - #endif - - /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ - bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); - - /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ - if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) - { - /* Turn off the watchdog */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ - MagicBootKey = 0; - - // cppcheck-suppress constStatement - ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); - } -} - -/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then - * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. - */ -int main(void) -{ - SetupHardware(); - - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); - GlobalInterruptEnable(); - - while (RunBootloader || TicksSinceLastCommand++ < 0xFF) - { - MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); - USB_USBTask(); - } - - /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ - USB_Detach(); - - /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ - MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; - - /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ - wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); - - for (;;); -} - -/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ -static void SetupHardware(void) -{ - /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Disable clock division */ - clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); - - /* Hardware Initialization */ - LEDs_Init(); - USB_Init(); - - /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ - TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); - TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); -} - -/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ -ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) -{ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) -{ - /* Indicate USB enumerating */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via - * the status LEDs and stops the Mass Storage management task. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) -{ - /* Indicate USB not ready */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); -} - -/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) -{ - bool ConfigSuccess = true; - - /* Setup Mass Storage Data Endpoints */ - ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); - - /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); -} - -/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) -{ - MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); -} - -/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced - */ -bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - bool CommandSuccess; - - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); - CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); - - /* Signal that a command was processed, must not exit bootloader yet */ - TicksSinceLastCommand = 0; - - return CommandSuccess; -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h deleted file mode 100644 index c9ddee4d7f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,99 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderMassStorage.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/wdt.h> - #include <avr/power.h> - #include <avr/interrupt.h> - #include <string.h> - - #include "Descriptors.h" - #include "Config/AppConfig.h" - - #include "Lib/SCSI.h" - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> - - /* Preprocessor Checks: */ - #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) - #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. - #endif - - /* Macros: */ - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 - - /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ - #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 - - /* Global Variables: */ - extern bool RunBootloader; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - int main(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); - - void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_MASSSTORAGE_C) - static void SetupHardware(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - #endif - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 0fea9d9fb5..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,240 +0,0 @@ -/** \file - * - * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special - * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. - */ - -/** \mainpage Mass Storage Class USB AVR Bootloader - * - * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: - * - * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. - * - * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) - * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) - * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> - * \li ATMEGA32U2 - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> - * - * \section Sec_Info USB Information: - * - * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> - * <td>Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> - * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> - * <td>Bulk-Only Transport</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> - * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n - * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n - * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n - * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> - * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - * - * \section Sec_Description Project Description: - * - * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a Mass Storage device, capable of reading and writing a new binary - * firmware image file, to load firmware onto the AVR. - * - * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit - * into 6KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to - * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. - * - * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the - * bootloader from the normal user application. - * - * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device - * lockbits are set. - * - * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader - * - * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of - * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. - * - * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from - * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the - * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software - * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). - * - * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. - * - * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board - * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the - * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board - * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the - * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation - * - * This bootloader uses the Mass Storage drivers inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no additional - * drivers need to be supplied for correct operation. - * - * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application - * - * This bootloader is compatible with all operating systems that support the FAT12 file system format. To reprogram the - * device, overwrite a file stored on the virtual FAT filesystem with a new binary (BIN format) image. Remember to safely - * remove your device from the host using the host OS's ejection APIs, to ensure all data is correctly flushed to the - * bootloader's virtual filesystem and not cached in the OS's file system driver. - * - * The current device firmware can be read from the device by reading a file from the virtual FAT filesystem. Two files will - * be present: - * - <b>FLASH.BIN</b>, representing the AVR's internal flash memory - * - <b>EEPROM.BIN</b>, representing the AVR's internal EEPROM memory - * - * To convert an existing Intel HEX (.HEX) program file to a binary (.BIN) file suitable for this bootloader, run: - * \code - * avr-objcopy -O binary -R .eeprom -R .fuse -R .lock -R .signature input.hex output.bin - * \endcode - * From a terminal, replacing <tt>input.hex</tt> and <tt>output.bin</tt> with the respective input and output filenames. - * AVR EEPROM data files in Intel HEX format (.EEP) uses a similar technique: - * \code - * avr-objcopy -O binary input.eep output.bin - * \endcode - * - * \warning This bootloader is currently <b>incompatible with the Apple MacOS X OS Finder GUI</b>, due to the - * large amount of meta files this OS attempts to write to the disk along with the new binaries. On - * this platform, firmwares must be copied to the disk via the Terminal application only to prevent - * firmware corruption. - * - * \section Sec_API User Application API - * - * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, - * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. - * - * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the - * following layout: - * - * \code - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) - * - * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_SIGNATURE 0xDF30 - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 - * \endcode - * - * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address - * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader - * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them - * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes - * of FLASH memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. - * - * \subsection SSec_Aux_Space Auxiliary Bootloader Section - * To make the bootloader function on smaller devices (those with a physical bootloader section of smaller than 6KB) a second - * section of memory (called the <i>Auxiliary Bootloader Section</i>) is added before the start of the real bootloader section, - * and is filled with a portion of the bootloader code. This allows smaller devices to run the bootloader, at the cost of an - * additional portion of the device's FLASH (the bootloader section size in KB subtracted from the 6KB total size). A small - * trampoline is inserted at the start of the auxiliary section so that the bootloader will run normally in the case of a blank - * application section. - * - * On devices supporting a 8KB bootloader section size, the AUX section is not created in the final binary. - * - * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map - * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. - * - * \verbatim - * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | User Application | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE - * | Booloader Start Trampoline | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE + 4 - * | | - * | Auxiliary Bootloader | - * | Space for Smaller Devices | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - * | | - * | Bootloader Application | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 - * | API Table Trampolines | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 - * | Bootloader API Table | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 - * | Bootloader ID Constants | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - * \endverbatim - * - * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: - * - * \par In some cases, the application is not fully loaded into the device. - * Write-caching on some operating systems may interfere with the normal - * operation of the bootloader. Write caching should be disabled when using the - * Mass Storage bootloader, or the file system synced via an appropriate command - * (such as the OS's normal disk ejection command) before disconnecting the device. - * - * \section Sec_Options Project Options - * - * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> - * <th><b>Location:</b></th> - * <th><b>Description:</b></th> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td>NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT</td> - * <td>AppConfig.h</td> - * <td>Define to disable automatic start of the loaded application when the virtual - * Mass Storage disk is ejected on the host.</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - */ - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 92eb364dc9..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,47 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief Application Configuration Header File - * - * This is a header file which is be used to configure LUFA's - * compile time options, as an alternative to the compile time - * constants supplied through a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the - * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. - */ - -#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ -#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ - -// #define NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT - -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 7353178673..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,93 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File - * - * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, - * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through - * a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA - * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". - */ - -#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ -#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ - - #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) - - /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ -// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES - - /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY -// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH - - /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG - #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) - #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY -// #define USB_HOST_ONLY -// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT - #define NO_SOF_EVENTS - - /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS - #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL - #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 - #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 - #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 -// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE - #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT - #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP - #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER - - /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} -// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT -// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE - - #else - - #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. - - #endif -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c deleted file mode 100644 index e8bdbd4f5c..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,157 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special - * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine - * the device's capabilities and functions. - */ - -#include "Descriptors.h" - - -/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall - * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the - * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration - * process begins. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = -{ - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, - - .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, - .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, - .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, - - .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, - - .VendorID = 0x03EB, - .ProductID = 0x2045, - .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), - - .ManufacturerStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - .ProductStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS -}; - -/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage - * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces - * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting - * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = -{ - .Config = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, - - .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), - .TotalInterfaces = 1, - - .ConfigurationNumber = 1, - .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, - - .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) - }, - - .MS_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, - .AlternateSetting = 0, - - .TotalEndpoints = 2, - - .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, - .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, - .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .MS_DataInEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - }, - - .MS_DataOutEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - } -}; - -/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" - * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given - * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function - * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the - * USB host. - */ -uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) -{ - const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); - - const void* Address = NULL; - uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; - - /* If/Else If chain compiles slightly smaller than a switch case */ - if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Device) - { - Address = &DeviceDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); - } - else if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Configuration) - { - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); - } - - *DescriptorAddress = Address; - return Size; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h deleted file mode 100644 index 506f41af83..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,88 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for Descriptors.c. - */ - -#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ -#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/pgmspace.h> - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include "BootloaderAPI.h" - - /* Macros: */ - /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ - #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) - - /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ - #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) - - /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ - #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the - * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which - * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; - - // Mass Storage Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; - } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; - - - /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor - * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the - * interface from other descriptors. - */ - enum InterfaceDescriptors_t - { - INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) - ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c deleted file mode 100644 index 3c14eb9010..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,294 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage - * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, - * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. - */ - -#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C -#include "SCSI.h" - -/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's - * features and capabilities. - */ -static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = - { - .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, - .PeripheralQualifier = 0, - - .Removable = true, - - .Version = 0, - - .ResponseDataFormat = 2, - .NormACA = false, - .TrmTsk = false, - .AERC = false, - - .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, - - .SoftReset = false, - .CmdQue = false, - .Linked = false, - .Sync = false, - .WideBus16Bit = false, - .WideBus32Bit = false, - .RelAddr = false, - - .VendorID = "LUFA", - .ProductID = "Bootloader", - .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, - }; - -/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE - * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. - */ -static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = - { - .ResponseCode = 0x70, - .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, - }; - - -/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches - * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns - * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise - */ -bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - bool CommandSuccess = false; - - /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ - switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) - { - case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: - CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); - break; - case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: -#if !defined(NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT) - /* If the user ejected the volume, signal bootloader exit at next opportunity. */ - RunBootloader = ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4] & 0x03) != 0x02); -#endif - case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: - case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: - case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: - case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: - /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ - CommandSuccess = true; - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; - break; - default: - /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ - SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, - SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, - SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); - break; - } - - /* Check if command was successfully processed */ - if (CommandSuccess) - { - SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, - SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, - SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); - - return true; - } - - return false; -} - -/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features - * and capabilities to the host. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. - */ -static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); - uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); - - /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ - if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) - { - /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ - SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, - SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, - SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); - - return false; - } - - Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); - - /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ - Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); - - /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; - - return true; -} - -/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, - * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. - */ -static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; - uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); - - Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); - Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; - - return true; -} - -/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity - * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. - */ -static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - Endpoint_Write_32_BE(LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); - Endpoint_Write_32_BE(SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES); - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; - - return true; -} - -/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address - * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual - * reading and writing of the data. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. - */ -static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, - const bool IsDataRead) -{ - uint16_t BlockAddress; - uint16_t TotalBlocks; - - /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ - BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); - - /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ - TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); - - /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ - if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) - { - /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ - SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, - SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, - SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); - - return false; - } - - /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ - for (uint16_t i = 0; i < TotalBlocks; i++) - { - if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) - VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(BlockAddress + i); - else - VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(BlockAddress + i); - } - - /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES); - - return true; -} - -/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about - * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. - * - * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with - * - * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. - */ -static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) -{ - /* Send an empty header response indicating Write Protect flag is off */ - Endpoint_Write_32_LE(0); - Endpoint_ClearIN(); - - /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ - MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; - - return true; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4195593363..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,84 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for SCSI.c. - */ - -#ifndef _SCSI_H_ -#define _SCSI_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/pgmspace.h> - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include "../BootloaderMassStorage.h" - #include "../Descriptors.h" - #include "VirtualFAT.h" - - /* Macros: */ - /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This - * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about - * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. - * - * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to - * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to - * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to - */ - #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ - SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ - SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) - - /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ - #define DATA_READ true - - /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ - #define DATA_WRITE false - - /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ - #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) - static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, - const bool IsDataRead) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - #endif - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c deleted file mode 100644 index ffd453128e..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,482 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Virtualized FAT12 filesystem implementation, to perform self-programming - * in response to read and write requests to the virtual filesystem by the - * host PC. - */ - -#define INCLUDE_FROM_VIRTUAL_FAT_C -#include "VirtualFAT.h" - -/** FAT filesystem boot sector block, must be the first sector on the physical - * disk so that the host can identify the presence of a FAT filesystem. This - * block is truncated; normally a large bootstrap section is located near the - * end of the block for booting purposes however as this is not meant to be a - * bootable disk it is omitted for space reasons. - * - * \note When returning the boot block to the host, the magic signature 0xAA55 - * must be added to the very end of the block to identify it as a boot - * block. - */ -static const FATBootBlock_t BootBlock = - { - .Bootstrap = {0xEB, 0x3C, 0x90}, - .Description = "mkdosfs", - .SectorSize = SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES, - .SectorsPerCluster = SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER, - .ReservedSectors = 1, - .FATCopies = 2, - .RootDirectoryEntries = (SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES / sizeof(FATDirectoryEntry_t)), - .TotalSectors16 = LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS, - .MediaDescriptor = 0xF8, - .SectorsPerFAT = 1, - .SectorsPerTrack = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS % 64), - .Heads = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS / 64), - .HiddenSectors = 0, - .TotalSectors32 = 0, - .PhysicalDriveNum = 0, - .ExtendedBootRecordSig = 0x29, - .VolumeSerialNumber = 0x12345678, - .VolumeLabel = "LUFA BOOT ", - .FilesystemIdentifier = "FAT12 ", - }; - -/** FAT 8.3 style directory entry, for the virtual FLASH contents file. */ -static FATDirectoryEntry_t FirmwareFileEntries[] = - { - /* Root volume label entry; disk label is contained in the Filename and - * Extension fields (concatenated) with a special attribute flag - other - * fields are ignored. Should be the same as the label in the boot block. - */ - [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_VolumeID] = - { - .MSDOS_Directory = - { - .Name = "LUFA BOOT ", - .Attributes = FAT_FLAG_VOLUME_NAME, - .Reserved = {0}, - .CreationTime = 0, - .CreationDate = 0, - .StartingCluster = 0, - .Reserved2 = 0, - } - }, - - /* VFAT Long File Name entry for the virtual firmware file; required to - * prevent corruption from systems that are unable to detect the device - * as being a legacy MSDOS style FAT12 volume. */ - [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_LFN] = - { - .VFAT_LongFileName = - { - .Ordinal = 1 | FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY, - .Attribute = FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME, - .Reserved1 = 0, - .Reserved2 = 0, - - .Checksum = FAT_CHECKSUM('F','L','A','S','H',' ',' ',' ','B','I','N'), - - .Unicode1 = 'F', - .Unicode2 = 'L', - .Unicode3 = 'A', - .Unicode4 = 'S', - .Unicode5 = 'H', - .Unicode6 = '.', - .Unicode7 = 'B', - .Unicode8 = 'I', - .Unicode9 = 'N', - .Unicode10 = 0, - .Unicode11 = 0, - .Unicode12 = 0, - .Unicode13 = 0, - } - }, - - /* MSDOS file entry for the virtual Firmware image. */ - [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS] = - { - .MSDOS_File = - { - .Filename = "FLASH ", - .Extension = "BIN", - .Attributes = 0, - .Reserved = {0}, - .CreationTime = FAT_TIME(1, 1, 0), - .CreationDate = FAT_DATE(14, 2, 1989), - .StartingCluster = 2, - .FileSizeBytes = FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES, - } - }, - - [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_LFN] = - { - .VFAT_LongFileName = - { - .Ordinal = 1 | FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY, - .Attribute = FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME, - .Reserved1 = 0, - .Reserved2 = 0, - - .Checksum = FAT_CHECKSUM('E','E','P','R','O','M',' ',' ','B','I','N'), - - .Unicode1 = 'E', - .Unicode2 = 'E', - .Unicode3 = 'P', - .Unicode4 = 'R', - .Unicode5 = 'O', - .Unicode6 = 'M', - .Unicode7 = '.', - .Unicode8 = 'B', - .Unicode9 = 'I', - .Unicode10 = 'N', - .Unicode11 = 0, - .Unicode12 = 0, - .Unicode13 = 0, - } - }, - - [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS] = - { - .MSDOS_File = - { - .Filename = "EEPROM ", - .Extension = "BIN", - .Attributes = 0, - .Reserved = {0}, - .CreationTime = FAT_TIME(1, 1, 0), - .CreationDate = FAT_DATE(14, 2, 1989), - .StartingCluster = 2 + FILE_CLUSTERS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES), - .FileSizeBytes = EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES, - } - }, - }; - -/** Starting cluster of the virtual FLASH.BIN file on disk, tracked so that the - * offset from the start of the data sector can be determined. On Windows - * systems files are usually replaced using the original file's disk clusters, - * while Linux appears to overwrite with an offset which must be compensated for. - */ -static const uint16_t* FLASHFileStartCluster = &FirmwareFileEntries[DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS].MSDOS_File.StartingCluster; - -/** Starting cluster of the virtual EEPROM.BIN file on disk, tracked so that the - * offset from the start of the data sector can be determined. On Windows - * systems files are usually replaced using the original file's disk clusters, - * while Linux appears to overwrite with an offset which must be compensated for. - */ -static const uint16_t* EEPROMFileStartCluster = &FirmwareFileEntries[DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS].MSDOS_File.StartingCluster; - -/** Reads a byte of EEPROM out from the EEPROM memory space. - * - * \note This function is required as the avr-libc EEPROM functions do not cope - * with linker relaxations, and a jump longer than 4K of FLASH on the - * larger USB AVRs will break the linker. This function is marked as - * never inlinable and placed into the normal text segment so that the - * call to the EEPROM function will be short even if the AUX boot section - * is used. - * - * \param[in] Address Address of the EEPROM location to read from - * - * \return Read byte of EEPROM data. - */ -static uint8_t ReadEEPROMByte(const uint8_t* const Address) -{ - return eeprom_read_byte(Address); -} - -/** Writes a byte of EEPROM out to the EEPROM memory space. - * - * \note This function is required as the avr-libc EEPROM functions do not cope - * with linker relaxations, and a jump longer than 4K of FLASH on the - * larger USB AVRs will break the linker. This function is marked as - * never inlinable and placed into the normal text segment so that the - * call to the EEPROM function will be short even if the AUX boot section - * is used. - * - * \param[in] Address Address of the EEPROM location to write to - * \param[in] Data New data to write to the EEPROM location - */ -static void WriteEEPROMByte(uint8_t* const Address, - const uint8_t Data) -{ - eeprom_update_byte(Address, Data); -} - -/** Updates a FAT12 cluster entry in the FAT file table with the specified next - * chain index. If the cluster is the last in the file chain, the magic value - * \c 0xFFF should be used. - * - * \note FAT data cluster indexes are offset by 2, so that cluster 2 is the - * first file data cluster on the disk. See the FAT specification. - * - * \param[out] FATTable Pointer to the FAT12 allocation table - * \param[in] Index Index of the cluster entry to update - * \param[in] ChainEntry Next cluster index in the file chain - */ -static void UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(uint8_t* const FATTable, - const uint16_t Index, - const uint16_t ChainEntry) -{ - /* Calculate the starting offset of the cluster entry in the FAT12 table */ - uint8_t FATOffset = (Index + (Index >> 1)); - bool UpperNibble = ((Index & 1) != 0); - - /* Check if the start of the entry is at an upper nibble of the byte, fill - * out FAT12 entry as required */ - if (UpperNibble) - { - FATTable[FATOffset] = (FATTable[FATOffset] & 0x0F) | ((ChainEntry & 0x0F) << 4); - FATTable[FATOffset + 1] = (ChainEntry >> 4); - } - else - { - FATTable[FATOffset] = ChainEntry; - FATTable[FATOffset + 1] = (FATTable[FATOffset] & 0xF0) | (ChainEntry >> 8); - } -} - -/** Updates a FAT12 cluster chain in the FAT file table with a linear chain of - * the specified length. - * - * \note FAT data cluster indexes are offset by 2, so that cluster 2 is the - * first file data cluster on the disk. See the FAT specification. - * - * \param[out] FATTable Pointer to the FAT12 allocation table - * \param[in] Index Index of the start of the cluster chain to update - * \param[in] ChainLength Length of the chain to write, in clusters - */ -static void UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(uint8_t* const FATTable, - const uint16_t Index, - const uint8_t ChainLength) -{ - for (uint8_t i = 0; i < ChainLength; i++) - { - uint16_t CurrentCluster = Index + i; - uint16_t NextCluster = CurrentCluster + 1; - - /* Mark last cluster as end of file */ - if (i == (ChainLength - 1)) - NextCluster = 0xFFF; - - UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(FATTable, CurrentCluster, NextCluster); - } -} - -/** Reads or writes a block of data from/to the physical device FLASH using a - * block buffer stored in RAM, if the requested block is within the virtual - * firmware file's sector ranges in the emulated FAT file system. - * - * \param[in] BlockNumber Physical disk block to read from/write to - * \param[in,out] BlockBuffer Pointer to the start of the block buffer in RAM - * \param[in] Read If \c true, the requested block is read, if - * \c false, the requested block is written - */ -static void ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, - uint8_t* BlockBuffer, - const bool Read) -{ - uint16_t FileStartBlock = DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock + (*FLASHFileStartCluster - 2) * SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER; - uint16_t FileEndBlock = FileStartBlock + (FILE_SECTORS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) - 1); - - /* Range check the write request - abort if requested block is not within the - * virtual firmware file sector range */ - if (!((BlockNumber >= FileStartBlock) && (BlockNumber <= FileEndBlock))) - return; - - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - uint32_t FlashAddress = (uint32_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; - #else - uint16_t FlashAddress = (uint16_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; - #endif - - if (Read) - { - /* Read out the mapped block of data from the device's FLASH */ - for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) - { - #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) - BlockBuffer[i] = pgm_read_byte_far(FlashAddress++); - #else - BlockBuffer[i] = pgm_read_byte(FlashAddress++); - #endif - } - } - else - { - /* Write out the mapped block of data to the device's FLASH */ - for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i += 2) - { - if ((FlashAddress % SPM_PAGESIZE) == 0) - { - /* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */ - BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(FlashAddress); - } - - /* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */ - BootloaderAPI_FillWord(FlashAddress, (BlockBuffer[i + 1] << 8) | BlockBuffer[i]); - FlashAddress += 2; - - if ((FlashAddress % SPM_PAGESIZE) == 0) - { - /* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */ - BootloaderAPI_WritePage(FlashAddress - SPM_PAGESIZE); - } - } - } -} - -/** Reads or writes a block of data from/to the physical device EEPROM using a - * block buffer stored in RAM, if the requested block is within the virtual - * firmware file's sector ranges in the emulated FAT file system. - * - * \param[in] BlockNumber Physical disk block to read from/write to - * \param[in,out] BlockBuffer Pointer to the start of the block buffer in RAM - * \param[in] Read If \c true, the requested block is read, if - * \c false, the requested block is written - */ -static void ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, - uint8_t* BlockBuffer, - const bool Read) -{ - uint16_t FileStartBlock = DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock + (*EEPROMFileStartCluster - 2) * SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER; - uint16_t FileEndBlock = FileStartBlock + (FILE_SECTORS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) - 1); - - /* Range check the write request - abort if requested block is not within the - * virtual firmware file sector range */ - if (!((BlockNumber >= FileStartBlock) && (BlockNumber <= FileEndBlock))) - return; - - uint16_t EEPROMAddress = (uint16_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; - - if (Read) - { - /* Read out the mapped block of data from the device's EEPROM */ - for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) - BlockBuffer[i] = ReadEEPROMByte((uint8_t*)EEPROMAddress++); - } - else - { - /* Write out the mapped block of data to the device's EEPROM */ - for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) - WriteEEPROMByte((uint8_t*)EEPROMAddress++, BlockBuffer[i]); - } -} - -/** Writes a block of data to the virtual FAT filesystem, from the USB Mass - * Storage interface. - * - * \param[in] BlockNumber Index of the block to write. - */ -void VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) -{ - uint8_t BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES]; - - /* Buffer the entire block to be written from the host */ - Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(BlockBuffer, sizeof(BlockBuffer), NULL); - Endpoint_ClearOUT(); - - switch (BlockNumber) - { - case DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock: - case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1: - case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2: - /* Ignore writes to the boot and FAT blocks */ - - break; - - case DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock: - /* Copy over the updated directory entries */ - memcpy(FirmwareFileEntries, BlockBuffer, sizeof(FirmwareFileEntries)); - - break; - - default: - ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, false); - ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, false); - - break; - } -} - -/** Reads a block of data from the virtual FAT filesystem, and sends it to the - * host via the USB Mass Storage interface. - * - * \param[in] BlockNumber Index of the block to read. - */ -void VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) -{ - uint8_t BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES]; - memset(BlockBuffer, 0x00, sizeof(BlockBuffer)); - - switch (BlockNumber) - { - case DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock: - memcpy(BlockBuffer, &BootBlock, sizeof(FATBootBlock_t)); - - /* Add the magic signature to the end of the block */ - BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES - 2] = 0x55; - BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES - 1] = 0xAA; - - break; - - case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1: - case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2: - /* Cluster 0: Media type/Reserved */ - UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(BlockBuffer, 0, 0xF00 | BootBlock.MediaDescriptor); - - /* Cluster 1: Reserved */ - UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(BlockBuffer, 1, 0xFFF); - - /* Cluster 2 onwards: Cluster chain of FLASH.BIN */ - UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(BlockBuffer, *FLASHFileStartCluster, FILE_CLUSTERS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES)); - - /* Cluster 2+n onwards: Cluster chain of EEPROM.BIN */ - UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(BlockBuffer, *EEPROMFileStartCluster, FILE_CLUSTERS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES)); - - break; - - case DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock: - memcpy(BlockBuffer, FirmwareFileEntries, sizeof(FirmwareFileEntries)); - - break; - - default: - ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, true); - ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, true); - - break; - } - - /* Write the entire read block Buffer to the host */ - Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(BlockBuffer, sizeof(BlockBuffer), NULL); - Endpoint_ClearIN(); -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h deleted file mode 100644 index ea80eae4d6..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,302 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -#ifndef _VIRTUALFAT_H_ -#define _VIRTUALFAT_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/pgmspace.h> - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include "../BootloaderAPI.h" - - /* Macros: */ - /** Size of the virtual FLASH.BIN file in bytes. */ - #define FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES (FLASHEND - (FLASHEND - BOOT_START_ADDR) - AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE) - - /** Size of the virtual EEPROM.BIN file in bytes. */ - #define EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES E2END - - /** Number of sectors that comprise a single logical disk cluster. */ - #define SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER 4 - - /** Size of a single logical sector on the disk. */ - #define SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES 512 - - /** Size of a logical cluster on the disk, in bytes */ - #define CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES (SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) - - /** Number of sectors required to store a given size in bytes. - * - * \param[in] size Size of the data that needs to be stored - * - * \return Number of sectors required to store the given data on the disk. - */ - #define FILE_SECTORS(size) ((size / SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) + ((size % SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) ? 1 : 0)) - - /** Number of clusters required to store a given size in bytes. - * - * \param[in] size Size of the data that needs to be stored - * - * \return Number of clusters required to store the given data on the disk. - */ - #define FILE_CLUSTERS(size) ((size / CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES) + ((size % CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES) ? 1 : 0)) - - /** Total number of logical sectors/blocks on the disk. */ - #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (FILE_SECTORS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) + FILE_SECTORS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) + 32) - - /** Converts a given time in HH:MM:SS format to a FAT filesystem time. - * - * \note The minimum seconds resolution of FAT is 2, thus odd seconds - * will be truncated to the previous integer multiple of 2 seconds. - * - * \param[in] hh Hours (0-23) - * \param[in] mm Minutes (0-59) - * \param[in] ss Seconds (0-59) - * - * \return Given time encoded as a FAT filesystem timestamp - */ - #define FAT_TIME(hh, mm, ss) ((hh << 11) | (mm << 5) | (ss >> 1)) - - /** Converts a given date in DD/MM/YYYY format to a FAT filesystem date. - * - * \param[in] dd Days in the month (1-31) - * \param[in] mm Months in the year (1-12) - * \param[in] yyyy Year (1980 - 2107) - * - * \return Given date encoded as a FAT filesystem datestamp - */ - #define FAT_DATE(dd, mm, yyyy) (((yyyy - 1980) << 9) | (mm << 5) | (dd << 0)) - - /** Bit-rotates a given 8-bit value once to the right. - * - * \param[in] x Value to rotate right once - * - * \return Bit-rotated input value, rotated once to the right. - */ - #define ROT8(x) ((((x) & 0xFE) >> 1) | (((x) & 1) ? 0x80 : 0x00)) - - /** Computes the LFN entry checksum of a MSDOS 8.3 format file entry, - * to associate a LFN entry with its short file entry. - * - * \param[in] n0 MSDOS Filename character 1 - * \param[in] n1 MSDOS Filename character 2 - * \param[in] n2 MSDOS Filename character 3 - * \param[in] n3 MSDOS Filename character 4 - * \param[in] n4 MSDOS Filename character 5 - * \param[in] n5 MSDOS Filename character 6 - * \param[in] n6 MSDOS Filename character 7 - * \param[in] n7 MSDOS Filename character 8 - * \param[in] e0 MSDOS Extension character 1 - * \param[in] e1 MSDOS Extension character 2 - * \param[in] e2 MSDOS Extension character 3 - * - * \return LFN checksum of the given MSDOS 8.3 filename. - */ - #define FAT_CHECKSUM(n0, n1, n2, n3, n4, n5, n6, n7, e0, e1, e2) \ - (uint8_t)(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(n0)+n1)+n2)+n3)+n4)+n5)+n6)+n7)+e0)+e1)+e2) - - /** \name FAT Filesystem Flags */ - //@{ - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a read-only file. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_READONLY (1 << 0) - - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a hidden file. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_HIDDEN (1 << 1) - - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a system file. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_SYSTEM (1 << 2) - - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a Volume name entry. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_VOLUME_NAME (1 << 3) - - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a directory entry. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_DIRECTORY (1 << 4) - - /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a file ready for archiving. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_ARCHIVE (1 << 5) - - /** FAT pseudo-attribute flag to indicate a Long File Name entry. */ - #define FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME 0x0F - - /** Ordinal flag marker for FAT Long File Name entries to mark the last entry. */ - #define FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY (1 << 6) - //@} - - /* Enums: */ - /** Enum for the Root FAT file entry indexes on the disk. This can be used - * to retrieve the current contents of a known directory entry. - */ - enum - { - /** Volume ID directory entry, giving the name of the virtual disk. */ - DISK_FILE_ENTRY_VolumeID = 0, - /** Long File Name FAT file entry of the virtual FLASH.BIN image file. */ - DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_LFN = 1, - /** Legacy MSDOS FAT file entry of the virtual FLASH.BIN image file. */ - DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS = 2, - /** Long File Name FAT file entry of the virtual EEPROM.BIN image file. */ - DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_LFN = 3, - /** Legacy MSDOS FAT file entry of the virtual EEPROM.BIN image file. */ - DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS = 4, - }; - - /** Enum for the physical disk blocks of the virtual disk. */ - enum - { - /** Boot sector disk block. */ - DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock = 0, - /** First copy of the FAT table block. */ - DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1 = 1, - /** Second copy of the FAT table block. */ - DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2 = 2, - /** Root file and directory entries block. */ - DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock = 3, - /** Start block of the disk data section. */ - DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock = 4, - }; - - /* Type Definitions: */ - /** FAT boot block structure definition, used to identify the core - * parameters of a FAT file system stored on a disk. - * - * \note This definition is truncated to save space; the magic signature - * \c 0xAA55 must be appended to the very end of the block for it - * to be detected by the host as a valid boot block. - */ - typedef struct - { - uint8_t Bootstrap[3]; - uint8_t Description[8]; - uint16_t SectorSize; - uint8_t SectorsPerCluster; - uint16_t ReservedSectors; - uint8_t FATCopies; - uint16_t RootDirectoryEntries; - uint16_t TotalSectors16; - uint8_t MediaDescriptor; - uint16_t SectorsPerFAT; - uint16_t SectorsPerTrack; - uint16_t Heads; - uint32_t HiddenSectors; - uint32_t TotalSectors32; - uint16_t PhysicalDriveNum; - uint8_t ExtendedBootRecordSig; - uint32_t VolumeSerialNumber; - uint8_t VolumeLabel[11]; - uint8_t FilesystemIdentifier[8]; - /* uint8_t BootstrapProgram[448]; */ - /* uint16_t MagicSignature; */ - } FATBootBlock_t; - - /** FAT directory entry structure, for the various kinds of File and - * directory descriptors on a FAT disk. - */ - typedef union - { - /** VFAT Long File Name file entry. */ - struct - { - uint8_t Ordinal; - uint16_t Unicode1; - uint16_t Unicode2; - uint16_t Unicode3; - uint16_t Unicode4; - uint16_t Unicode5; - uint8_t Attribute; - uint8_t Reserved1; - uint8_t Checksum; - uint16_t Unicode6; - uint16_t Unicode7; - uint16_t Unicode8; - uint16_t Unicode9; - uint16_t Unicode10; - uint16_t Unicode11; - uint16_t Reserved2; - uint16_t Unicode12; - uint16_t Unicode13; - } VFAT_LongFileName; - - /** Legacy FAT MSDOS 8.3 file entry. */ - struct - { - uint8_t Filename[8]; - uint8_t Extension[3]; - uint8_t Attributes; - uint8_t Reserved[10]; - uint16_t CreationTime; - uint16_t CreationDate; - uint16_t StartingCluster; - uint32_t FileSizeBytes; - } MSDOS_File; - - /** Legacy FAT MSDOS (sub-)directory entry. */ - struct - { - uint8_t Name[11]; - uint8_t Attributes; - uint8_t Reserved[10]; - uint16_t CreationTime; - uint16_t CreationDate; - uint16_t StartingCluster; - uint32_t Reserved2; - } MSDOS_Directory; - } FATDirectoryEntry_t; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_VIRTUAL_FAT_C) - static uint8_t ReadEEPROMByte(const uint8_t* const Address) ATTR_NO_INLINE; - - static void WriteEEPROMByte(uint8_t* const Address, - const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NO_INLINE; - - static void UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(uint8_t* const FATTable, - const uint16_t Index, - const uint16_t ChainEntry) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - static void UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(uint8_t* const FATTable, - const uint16_t StartIndex, - const uint8_t ChainLength) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - static void ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, - uint8_t* BlockBuffer, - const bool Read) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - - static void ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, - uint8_t* BlockBuffer, - const bool Read) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - #endif - - void VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - void VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; - -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 700ffa26ff..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,156 +0,0 @@ -<asf xmlversion="1.0"> - <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 8KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.128_8" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_128kb_8kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1E000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1E000"/> - - <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="0"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 8KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.64_8" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_64kb_8kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb647"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xE000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xE000"/> - - <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="0"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot (2KB AUX) - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_32kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega32u4"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/> - - <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="2048"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux=0x6810"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux_trampoline=0x6800"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=Boot_AUX_Trampoline"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot (2KB AUX) - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_16kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega16u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/> - - <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="2048"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux=0x2810"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux_trampoline=0x2800"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=Boot_AUX_Trampoline"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage" caption="Mass Storage Bootloader"> - <info type="description" value="summary"> - Mass Storage Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device via binary BIN files copied to the virtual FAT12 file-system it creates when plugged into a host. - </info> - - <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> - - <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> - <keyword value="Bootloaders"/> - <keyword value="USB Device"/> - </info> - - <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="."/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderMassStorage.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderMassStorage.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/> - <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/> - - <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="Lib"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Lib/VirtualFAT.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Lib/VirtualFAT.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/> - - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderMassStorage.txt"/> - - <require idref="lufa.common"/> - <require idref="lufa.platform"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> - </module> -</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile deleted file mode 100644 index 795c6e81ad..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2396 +0,0 @@ -# Doxyfile 1.8.9 - -# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system -# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. -# -# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in -# front of the TAG it is preceding. -# -# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. -# The format is: -# TAG = value [value, ...] -# For lists, items can also be appended using: -# TAG += value [value, ...] -# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Project related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file -# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text -# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv -# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv -# for the list of possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by -# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the -# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the -# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. -# The default value is: My Project. - -PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Class Bootloader" - -# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This -# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version -# control system is used. - -PROJECT_NUMBER = - -# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description -# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a -# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. - -PROJECT_BRIEF = - -# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included -# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 -# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy -# the logo to the output directory. - -PROJECT_LOGO = - -# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path -# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is -# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If -# left blank the current directory will be used. - -OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ - -# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- -# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and -# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this -# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where -# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes -# performance problems for the file system. -# The default value is: NO. - -CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO - -# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII -# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII -# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode -# U+3044. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO - -# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all -# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this -# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. -# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, -# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), -# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, -# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), -# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, -# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, -# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, -# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. -# The default value is: English. - -OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English - -# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member -# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class -# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. -# The default value is: YES. - -BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES - -# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief -# description of a member or function before the detailed description -# -# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the -# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. -# The default value is: YES. - -REPEAT_BRIEF = YES - -# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is -# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found -# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text -# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated -# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the -# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of -# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, -# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. - -ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ - "The $name widget" \ - "The $name file" \ - is \ - provides \ - specifies \ - contains \ - represents \ - a \ - an \ - the - -# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then -# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief -# description. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO - -# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all -# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those -# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment -# operators of the base classes will not be shown. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO - -# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path -# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the -# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used -# The default value is: YES. - -FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES - -# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. -# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand -# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. -# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to -# strip. -# -# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which -# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. -# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. - -STRIP_FROM_PATH = - -# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the -# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which -# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of -# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should -# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler -# using the -I flag. - -STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = - -# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but -# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't -# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHORT_NAMES = YES - -# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the -# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief -# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- -# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief -# description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first -# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If -# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus -# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a -# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as -# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is -# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this -# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. -# -# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are -# not recognized any more. -# The default value is: NO. - -MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO - -# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the -# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. -# The default value is: YES. - -INHERIT_DOCS = YES - -# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new -# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part -# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. -# The default value is: NO. - -SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO - -# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen -# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. - -TAB_SIZE = 4 - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in -# the documentation. An alias has the form: -# name=value -# For example adding -# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" -# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the -# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading -# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert -# newlines. - -ALIASES = - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). -# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" -# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. - -TCL_SUBST = - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources -# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For -# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all -# members will be omitted, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or -# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored -# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, -# qualified scopes will look different, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO - -# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it -# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given -# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it -# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and -# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, -# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: -# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: -# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed -# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For -# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), -# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. -# -# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. -# -# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise -# the files are not read by doxygen. - -EXTENSION_MAPPING = - -# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments -# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable -# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. -# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can -# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in -# case of backward compatibilities issues. -# The default value is: YES. - -MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO - -# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented -# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can -# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or -# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES - -# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want -# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this -# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and -# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); -# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration -# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. -# The default value is: NO. - -BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO - -# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to -# enable parsing support. -# The default value is: NO. - -CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO - -# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: -# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen -# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead -# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. -# The default value is: NO. - -SIP_SUPPORT = NO - -# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate -# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make -# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. -# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple -# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you -# should set this option to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES - -# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC -# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first -# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default -# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. -# The default value is: NO. - -DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO - -# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type -# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that -# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent -# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the -# \nosubgrouping command. -# The default value is: YES. - -SUBGROUPING = YES - -# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions -# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) -# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX -# and RTF). -# -# Note that this feature does not work in combination with -# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO - -# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions -# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in -# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, -# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set -# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and -# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO - -# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or -# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So -# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct -# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, -# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be -# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound -# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. -# The default value is: NO. - -TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO - -# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This -# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be -# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the -# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small -# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The -# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range -# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 -# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest -# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. - -LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Build related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in -# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private -# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the -# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. -# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are -# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ALL = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will -# be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal -# scope will be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO - -# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_STATIC = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined -# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, -# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect -# for Java sources. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES - -# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, -# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are -# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are -# included. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO - -# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be -# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called -# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of -# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace -# are hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these -# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation -# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set -# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option -# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO - -# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend -# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO - -# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any -# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these -# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO - -# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a -# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation -# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INTERNAL_DOCS = NO - -# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file -# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also -# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ -# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows -# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. -# The default value is: system dependent. - -CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with -# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the -# scope will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will -# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to -# YES the compound reference will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO - -# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of -# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES - -# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each -# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader -# which file to include in order to use the member. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO - -# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include -# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. -# The default value is: NO. - -FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO - -# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the -# documentation for inline members. -# The default value is: YES. - -INLINE_INFO = YES - -# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. -# The default value is: YES. - -SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES - -# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief -# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that -# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO - -# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and -# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the -# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. -# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief -# member documentation. -# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting -# detailed member documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO - -# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy -# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will -# appear in their defined order. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO - -# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by -# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will -# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. -# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. -# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical -# list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO - -# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper -# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between -# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is -# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a -# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still -# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. -# The default value is: NO. - -STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO - -# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo -# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test -# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug -# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) -# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in -# the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES - -# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation -# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> -# ... \endcond blocks. - -ENABLED_SECTIONS = - -# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the -# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the -# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here -# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The -# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be -# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the -# documentation regardless of this setting. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. - -MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 - -# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at -# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the -# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_USED_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This -# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View -# (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces -# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the -# Folder Tree View (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES - -# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that -# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from -# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via -# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided -# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file -# version. For an example see the documentation. - -FILE_VERSION_FILTER = - -# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed -# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated -# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file -# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can -# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml -# will be used as the name of the layout file. -# -# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called -# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE -# tag is left empty. - -LAYOUT_FILE = - -# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing -# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib -# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool -# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. -# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using -# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the -# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. - -CITE_BIB_FILES = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to -# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the -# messages are off. -# The default value is: NO. - -QUIET = YES - -# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are -# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES -# this implies that the warnings are on. -# -# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARNINGS = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate -# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag -# will automatically be disabled. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for -# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters -# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using -# markup commands wrongly. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES - -# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that -# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return -# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete -# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES - -# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen -# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which -# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated -# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will -# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) -# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. - -WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" - -# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error -# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard -# error (stderr). - -WARN_LOGFILE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the input files -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain -# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or -# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with -# spaces. -# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. - -INPUT = ./ - -# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files -# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses -# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv -# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of -# possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the -# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, -# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, -# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, -# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, -# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. - -FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ - *.c \ - *.txt - -# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should -# be searched for input files as well. -# The default value is: NO. - -RECURSIVE = YES - -# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be -# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a -# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. -# -# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is -# run. - -EXCLUDE = Documentation/ - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or -# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded -# from the input. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude -# certain files from those directories. -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names -# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the -# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the -# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, -# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ - INCLUDE_FROM_* - -# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include -# command). - -EXAMPLE_PATH = - -# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all -# files are included. - -EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * - -# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be -# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands -# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO - -# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the -# \image command). - -IMAGE_PATH = - -# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should -# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program -# by executing (via popen()) the command: -# -# <filter> <input-file> -# -# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the -# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter -# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag -# will be ignored. -# -# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the -# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added -# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. - -INPUT_FILTER = - -# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern -# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the -# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter -# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how -# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the -# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. - -FILTER_PATTERNS = - -# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using -# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for -# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). -# The default value is: NO. - -FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO - -# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file -# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and -# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using -# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). -# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. - -FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = - -# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that -# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page -# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub -# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. - -USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to source browsing -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be -# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. -# -# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that -# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. -# The default value is: NO. - -SOURCE_BROWSER = NO - -# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, -# classes and enums directly into the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SOURCES = NO - -# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any -# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and -# Fortran comments will always remain visible. -# The default value is: YES. - -STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES - -# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented -# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function -# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCES_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set -# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and -# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will -# link to the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO - -# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the -# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, -# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this -# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you -# can opt to disable this feature. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES - -# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will -# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in -# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system -# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version -# 4.8.6 or higher. -# -# To use it do the following: -# - Install the latest version of global -# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file -# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree -# - Run doxygen as normal -# -# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these -# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). -# -# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to -# source code will now point to the output of htags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -USE_HTAGS = NO - -# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a -# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is -# specified. Set to NO to disable this. -# See also: Section \class. -# The default value is: YES. - -VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO - -# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the -# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the -# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template -# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type -# information. -# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was -# compiled with the --with-libclang option. -# The default value is: NO. - -CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO - -# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command -# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that -# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories -# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. -# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. - -CLANG_OPTIONS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all -# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of -# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. -# The default value is: YES. - -ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES - -# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in -# which the alphabetical index list will be split. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 - -# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will -# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag -# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored -# while generating the index headers. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -IGNORE_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the HTML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_HTML = YES - -# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_OUTPUT = html - -# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each -# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). -# The default value is: .html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html - -# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for -# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a -# standard header. -# -# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets -# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. -# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a -# default header using -# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css -# YourConfigFile -# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" -# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally -# uses. -# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the -# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description -# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_HEADER = - -# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each -# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard -# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default -# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer -# that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FOOTER = - -# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style -# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of -# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style -# sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as -# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become -# obsolete. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets -# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. -# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the -# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. -# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). For an example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note -# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the -# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these -# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the -# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_FILES = - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen -# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to -# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value -# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 -# purple, and 360 is red again. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors -# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A -# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the -# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 -# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output -# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents -# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not -# change the gamma. -# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 - -# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML -# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this -# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO - -# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML -# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the -# page has loaded. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES - -# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries -# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand -# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to -# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless -# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of -# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value -# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded -# tree by default. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 - -# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development -# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with -# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a -# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in -# that directory and running make install will install the docset in -# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at -# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html -# for more information. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_DOCSET = NO - -# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides -# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider -# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. -# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" - -# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation -# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. -# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify -# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style -# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. -# The default value is: Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher - -# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three -# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The -# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop -# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on -# Windows. -# -# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output -# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML -# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old -# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed -# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for -# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for -# compressed HTML files. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO - -# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm -# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be -# written to the html output directory. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_FILE = - -# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path -# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, -# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. -# The file has to be specified with full path. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -HHC_LOCATION = - -# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated -# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -GENERATE_CHI = NO - -# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) -# and project file content. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = - -# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated -# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it -# enables the Previous and Next buttons. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -BINARY_TOC = NO - -# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to -# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -TOC_EXPAND = YES - -# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and -# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that -# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help -# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_QHP = NO - -# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify -# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to -# the HTML output folder. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QCH_FILE = - -# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help -# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace -# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project - -# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt -# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual -# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- -# folders). -# The default value is: doc. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc - -# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom -# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = - -# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the -# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this -# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: -# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's -# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the -# generated .qhp file. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHG_LOCATION = - -# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To -# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in -# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs -# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory -# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. -# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO - -# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin -# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this -# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. - -ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might -# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The -# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top -# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables -# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation -# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -DISABLE_INDEX = YES - -# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index -# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag -# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like -# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this -# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required -# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the -# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can -# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style -# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at -# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has -# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting -# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES - -# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that -# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. -# -# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing -# in the overview section. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 - -# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used -# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 - -# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to -# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO - -# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in -# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful -# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML -# output directory to force them to be regenerated. -# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images -# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not -# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. -# -# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in -# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see -# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering -# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX -# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When -# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path -# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -USE_MATHJAX = NO - -# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for -# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: -# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. -# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best -# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. -# The default value is: HTML-CSS. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS - -# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML -# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory -# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory -# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then -# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax -# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing -# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of -# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. -# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest - -# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax -# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example -# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = - -# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces -# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site -# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an -# example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_CODEFILE = - -# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for -# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and -# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help -# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) -# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. -# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then -# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to -# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S -# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically -# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down -# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated -# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel -# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the -# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> -# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter -# option. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE = NO - -# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be -# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There -# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH -# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and -# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing -# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section -# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO - -# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP -# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file -# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an -# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the -# search results. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). -# -# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO - -# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server -# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and -# Searching" for details. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE_URL = - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed -# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the -# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. -# The default file is: searchdata.xml. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the -# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is -# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple -# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = - -# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen -# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are -# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a -# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of -# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: -# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_LATEX = NO - -# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_OUTPUT = latex - -# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be -# invoked. -# -# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating -# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is -# written to the output directory. -# The default file is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex - -# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate -# index for LaTeX. -# The default file is: makeindex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex - -# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -COMPACT_LATEX = NO - -# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the -# printer. -# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x -# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). -# The default value is: a4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PAPER_TYPE = a4wide - -# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names -# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for -# instance you can specify -# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times -# If left blank no extra packages will be included. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -EXTRA_PACKAGES = - -# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the -# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the -# default header to a separate file. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The -# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, -# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, -# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty -# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred -# to HTML_HEADER. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HEADER = - -# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the -# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See -# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what -# special commands can be used inside the footer. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_FOOTER = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created -# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen -# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output -# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or -# markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = - -# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is -# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will -# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This -# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES - -# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate -# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a -# higher quality PDF documentation. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -USE_PDFLATEX = YES - -# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode -# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running -# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used -# when generating formulas in HTML. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO - -# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the -# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO - -# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source -# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the -# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. -# The default value is: plain. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the RTF output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The -# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF -# readers/editors. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_RTF = NO - -# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: rtf. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_OUTPUT = rtf - -# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -COMPACT_RTF = NO - -# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will -# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML -# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online -# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those -# fields. -# -# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO - -# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config -# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, -# missing definitions are set to their default value. -# -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the -# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = - -# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is -# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated -# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = - -# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code -# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the man page output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for -# classes and files. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_MAN = NO - -# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by -# MAN_OUTPUT. -# The default directory is: man. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_OUTPUT = man - -# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated -# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number -# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is -# optional. -# The default value is: .3. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_EXTENSION = .3 - -# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within -# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by -# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_SUBDIR = - -# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it -# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real -# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without -# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_LINKS = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the XML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that -# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_XML = NO - -# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: xml. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_OUTPUT = xml - -# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program -# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to -# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size -# of the XML output. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files -# that can be used to generate PDF. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO - -# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. -# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in -# front of it. -# The default directory is: docbook. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook - -# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the -# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing -# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly -# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an -# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the -# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is -# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the Perl module output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module -# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# -# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary -# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI -# output from the Perl module output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_LATEX = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely -# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to -# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the -# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it -# just the same. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES - -# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are -# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful -# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't -# overwrite each other's variables. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the preprocessor -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all -# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. -# The default value is: YES. - -ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names -# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be -# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting -# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -MACRO_EXPANSION = YES - -# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then -# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and -# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES - -# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the -# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES - -# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the -# preprocessor. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_PATH = - -# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard -# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the -# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be -# used. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = - -# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are -# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. -# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or -# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" -# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or -# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ - PROGMEM \ - ATTR_NO_INIT - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this -# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The -# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED -# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the -# definition found in the source code. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = - -# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will -# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have -# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros -# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not -# removed. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to external references -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag -# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of -# a tag file without this location is as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... -# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... -# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the -# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use -# of tag files. -# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include -# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is -# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. - -TAGFILES = - -# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a -# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to -# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. - -GENERATE_TAGFILE = - -# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in -# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be -# listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLEXTERNALS = NO - -# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed -# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be -# listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES - -# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in -# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will -# be listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES - -# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script -# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). -# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. - -PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the dot tool -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram -# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to -# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT -# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more -# powerful graphs. -# The default value is: YES. - -CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO - -# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc -# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: -# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the -# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where -# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the -# default search path. - -MSCGEN_PATH = - -# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will -# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The -# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. -# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. - -DIA_PATH = - -# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance -# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. -# The default value is: YES. - -HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES - -# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is -# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: -# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent -# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is -# set to NO -# The default value is: NO. - -HAVE_DOT = NO - -# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed -# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of -# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value -# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing -# speed. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 - -# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen -# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make -# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a -# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by -# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. -# The default value is: Helvetica. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTNAME = - -# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of -# dot graphs. -# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with -# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set -# the path where dot can find it using this tag. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTPATH = - -# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. -# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CLASS_GRAPH = NO - -# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a -# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation -# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the -# class with other documented classes. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GROUP_GRAPHS = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and -# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling -# Language. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LOOK = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the -# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may -# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the -# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 -# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit -# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, -# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to -# 10. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 - -# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and -# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their -# instances. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO - -# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to -# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the -# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO - -# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are -# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing -# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callgraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALL_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callergraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALLER_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical -# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO - -# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the -# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The -# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the -# files in the directories. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO - -# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images -# generated by dot. -# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order -# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this -# requirement). -# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. -# The default value is: png. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png - -# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to -# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. -# -# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested -# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. -# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make -# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO - -# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be -# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_PATH = - -# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile -# command). -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOTFILE_DIRS = - -# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile -# command). - -MSCFILE_DIRS = - -# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile -# command). - -DIAFILE_DIRS = - -# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the -# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed -# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will -# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and -# will not generate output for the diagram. - -PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = - -# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by -# the !include statement in a plantuml block. - -PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = - -# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes -# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes -# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized -# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct -# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that -# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 - -# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs -# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the -# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay -# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 -# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also -# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 - -# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent -# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem -# to support this out of the box. -# -# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to -# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to -# read). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output -# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This -# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support -# this, this feature is disabled by default. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO - -# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page -# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated -# graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GENERATE_LEGEND = YES - -# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot -# files that are used to generate the various graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index f3948e754f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,75 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# -# -------------------------------------- -# LUFA Project Makefile. -# -------------------------------------- - -# Run "make help" for target help. - -MCU = at90usb1287 -ARCH = AVR8 -BOARD = USBKEY -F_CPU = 8000000 -F_USB = $(F_CPU) -OPTIMIZATION = s -TARGET = BootloaderMassStorage -SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S Lib/SCSI.c Lib/VirtualFAT.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) -LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA -CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) - -# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must -# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the -# device's fuses. -FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128 -BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8 - -# Bootloader address calculation formulas -# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. -CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) -BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) -BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) - -# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to -# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. -BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) - -# Check if the bootloader needs an AUX section, located before the real bootloader section to store some of the -# bootloader code. This is required for 32KB and smaller devices, where the actual bootloader is 6KB but the maximum -# bootloader section size is 4KB. The actual usable application space will be reduced by 6KB for these devices. -ifeq ($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB),8) - CC_FLAGS += -DAUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE=0 -else - AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = (6 - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) - - CC_FLAGS += -DAUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE='($(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) * 1024)' - LD_FLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.boot_aux=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, (($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) + $(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 - 16)) - LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .boot_aux_trampoline, Boot_AUX_Trampoline, ($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) + $(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024) -endif - -# Default target -all: - -# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules -DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk - -# Include common DMBS build system modules -DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS -include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c deleted file mode 100644 index 2be1568082..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,75 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Bootloader user application API functions. - */ - -#include "BootloaderAPI.h" - -void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_erase_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) -{ - boot_page_write_safe(Address); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - boot_rww_enable(); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) -{ - boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); -} - -uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) -{ - return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); -} - -void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) -{ - boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h deleted file mode 100644 index c2d9b4a188..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,56 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/boot.h> - #include <stdbool.h> - - #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); - void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); - uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); - void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S deleted file mode 100644 index d8358c31ce..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S +++ /dev/null @@ -1,91 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the -; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) -.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines -BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: - - BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage - BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage - BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord - BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature - BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse - BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock - BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: - jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: - ret - BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: - ret - - - -; API function jump table -.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable -BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: - - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 - rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 - - - -; Bootloader table signatures and information -.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" -.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures -BootloaderAPI_Signatures: - - .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader - .word 0xDF20 ; Signature for the Printer class bootloader - .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c deleted file mode 100644 index 9021f998f7..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,487 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Main source file for the Printer class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. - */ - -#include "BootloaderPrinter.h" - -/** LUFA Printer Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is - * passed to all Printer Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class - * within a device can be differentiated from one another. - */ -USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t TextOnly_Printer_Interface = - { - .Config = - { - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Printer, - .DataINEndpoint = - { - .Address = PRINTER_IN_EPADDR, - .Size = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, - .Banks = 1, - }, - .DataOUTEndpoint = - { - .Address = PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR, - .Size = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, - .Banks = 1, - }, - .IEEE1284String = - "MFG:Generic;" - "MDL:Generic_/_Text_Only;" - "CMD:1284.4;" - "CLS:PRINTER", - }, - }; - -/** Intel HEX parser state machine state information, to track the contents of - * a HEX file streamed in as a sequence of arbitrary bytes. - */ -struct -{ - /** Current HEX parser state machine state. */ - uint8_t ParserState; - /** Previously decoded numerical byte of data. */ - uint8_t PrevData; - /** Currently decoded numerical byte of data. */ - uint8_t Data; - /** Indicates if both bytes that correspond to a single decoded numerical - * byte of data (HEX encodes values in ASCII HEX, two characters per byte) - * have been read. - */ - bool ReadMSB; - /** Intel HEX record type of the current Intel HEX record. */ - uint8_t RecordType; - /** Numerical bytes of data remaining to be read in the current record. */ - uint8_t DataRem; - /** Checksum of the current record received so far. */ - uint8_t Checksum; - /** Starting address of the last addressed FLASH page. */ - uint32_t PageStartAddress; - /** Current 32-bit byte extended base address in FLASH being targeted. */ - uint32_t CurrBaseAddress; - /** Current 32-bit byte address in FLASH being targeted. */ - uint32_t CurrAddress; -} HEXParser; - -/** Indicates if there is data waiting to be written to a physical page of - * memory in FLASH. - */ -static bool PageDirty = false; - -/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run - * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application - * started via a forced watchdog reset. - */ -static bool RunBootloader = true; - -/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader - * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held - * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value - * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. - */ -uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; - - -/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application - * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, - * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. - */ -void Application_Jump_Check(void) -{ - bool JumpToApplication = false; - - #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) - /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTC |= (1 << 7); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); - - /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ - PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); - #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) - /* Disable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_DISABLE(); - - /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ - PORTF |= (1 << 4); - Delay_MS(10); - - /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ - JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); - - /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ - JTAG_ENABLE(); - #else - /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ - if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) - { - /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ - if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); - } - else - { - /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; - * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ - if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) - JumpToApplication = true; - - /* Clear reset source */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - } - #endif - - /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ - bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); - - /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ - if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) - { - /* Turn off the watchdog */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ - MagicBootKey = 0; - - // cppcheck-suppress constStatement - ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); - } -} - -/** - * Converts a given input byte of data from an ASCII encoded HEX value to an integer value. - * - * \note Input HEX bytes are expected to be in uppercase only. - * - * \param[in] Byte ASCII byte of data to convert - * - * \return Integer converted value of the input ASCII encoded HEX byte of data, or -1 if the - * input is not valid ASCII encoded HEX. - */ -static int8_t HexToDecimal(const char Byte) -{ - if ((Byte >= 'A') && (Byte <= 'F')) - return (10 + (Byte - 'A')); - else if ((Byte >= '0') && (Byte <= '9')) - return (Byte - '0'); - - return -1; -} - -/** - * Flushes a partially written page of data to physical FLASH, if a page - * boundary has been crossed. - * - * \note If a page flush occurs the global HEX parser state is updated. - */ -static void FlushPageIfRequired(void) -{ - /* Abort if no data has been buffered for writing to the current page */ - if (!PageDirty) - return; - - /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ - uint32_t NewPageStartAddress = (HEXParser.CurrAddress & ~(SPM_PAGESIZE - 1)); - if (HEXParser.PageStartAddress != NewPageStartAddress) - { - boot_page_write(HEXParser.PageStartAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - HEXParser.PageStartAddress = NewPageStartAddress; - - PageDirty = false; - } -} - -/** - * Parses an input Intel HEX formatted stream one character at a time, loading - * the data contents into the device's internal FLASH memory. - * - * \param[in] ReadCharacter Next input ASCII byte of data to parse - */ -static void ParseIntelHEXByte(const char ReadCharacter) -{ - /* Reset the line parser while waiting for a new line to start */ - if ((HEXParser.ParserState == HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE) || (ReadCharacter == ':')) - { - HEXParser.Checksum = 0; - HEXParser.CurrAddress = HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress; - HEXParser.ReadMSB = false; - - /* ASCII ':' indicates the start of a new HEX record */ - if (ReadCharacter == ':') - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT; - - return; - } - - /* Only allow ASCII HEX encoded digits, ignore all other characters */ - int8_t ReadCharacterDec = HexToDecimal(ReadCharacter); - if (ReadCharacterDec < 0) - return; - - /* Read and convert the next nibble of data from the current character */ - HEXParser.Data = (HEXParser.Data << 4) | ReadCharacterDec; - HEXParser.ReadMSB = !HEXParser.ReadMSB; - - /* Only process further when a full byte (two nibbles) have been read */ - if (HEXParser.ReadMSB) - return; - - /* Intel HEX checksum is for all fields except starting character and the - * checksum itself - */ - if (HEXParser.ParserState != HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM) - HEXParser.Checksum += HEXParser.Data; - - switch (HEXParser.ParserState) - { - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT: - HEXParser.DataRem = HEXParser.Data; - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH; - break; - - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH: - HEXParser.CurrAddress += ((uint16_t)HEXParser.Data << 8); - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW; - break; - - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW: - HEXParser.CurrAddress += HEXParser.Data; - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE; - break; - - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE: - HEXParser.RecordType = HEXParser.Data; - HEXParser.ParserState = (HEXParser.DataRem ? HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA : HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM); - break; - - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA: - /* Track the number of read data bytes in the record */ - HEXParser.DataRem--; - - /* Protect the bootloader against being written to */ - if (HEXParser.CurrAddress >= BOOT_START_ADDR) - { - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; - PageDirty = false; - return; - } - - /* Wait for a machine word (two bytes) of data to be read */ - if (HEXParser.DataRem & 0x01) - { - HEXParser.PrevData = HEXParser.Data; - break; - } - - /* Convert the last two received data bytes into a 16-bit word */ - uint16_t NewDataWord = ((uint16_t)HEXParser.Data << 8) | HEXParser.PrevData; - - switch (HEXParser.RecordType) - { - case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_Data: - /* If we are writing to a new page, we need to erase it first */ - if (!(PageDirty)) - { - boot_page_erase(HEXParser.PageStartAddress); - boot_spm_busy_wait(); - - PageDirty = true; - } - - /* Fill the FLASH memory buffer with the new word of data */ - boot_page_fill(HEXParser.CurrAddress, NewDataWord); - HEXParser.CurrAddress += 2; - - /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ - FlushPageIfRequired(); - break; - - case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedSegmentAddress: - /* Extended address data - store the upper 12-bits of the new address */ - HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress = ((uint32_t)NewDataWord << 4); - break; - - case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedLinearAddress: - /* Extended address data - store the upper 16-bits of the new address */ - HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress = ((uint32_t)NewDataWord << 16); - break; - } - - if (!HEXParser.DataRem) - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM; - break; - - case HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM: - /* Verify checksum of the completed record */ - if (HEXParser.Data != ((~HEXParser.Checksum + 1) & 0xFF)) - break; - - /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ - FlushPageIfRequired(); - - /* If end of the HEX file reached, the bootloader should exit at next opportunity */ - if (HEXParser.RecordType == HEX_RECORD_TYPE_EndOfFile) - RunBootloader = false; - - break; - - default: - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; - break; - } -} - -/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then - * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. - */ -int main(void) -{ - SetupHardware(); - - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); - GlobalInterruptEnable(); - - while (RunBootloader) - { - uint8_t BytesReceived = PRNT_Device_BytesReceived(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); - - if (BytesReceived) - { - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); - - while (BytesReceived--) - { - int16_t ReceivedByte = PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); - - /* Feed the next byte of data to the HEX parser */ - ParseIntelHEXByte(ReceivedByte); - } - - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); - } - - PRNT_Device_USBTask(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); - USB_USBTask(); - } - - /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ - USB_Detach(); - - /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ - MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; - - /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ - wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); - - for (;;); -} - -/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ -static void SetupHardware(void) -{ - /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ - MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); - wdt_disable(); - - /* Disable clock division */ - clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); - - /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ - MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); - MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); - - /* Hardware Initialization */ - LEDs_Init(); - USB_Init(); - - /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ - TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); - TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); -} - -/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ -ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) -{ - LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) -{ - /* Indicate USB enumerating */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via - * the status LEDs and stops the Printer management task. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) -{ - /* Indicate USB not ready */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration - * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the Mass Storage management task started. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) -{ - bool ConfigSuccess = true; - - /* Setup Printer Data Endpoints */ - ConfigSuccess &= PRNT_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); - - /* Reset the HEX parser upon successful connection to a host */ - HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; - - /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ - LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); -} - -/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to - * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing - * internally. - */ -void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) -{ - PRNT_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); -} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8bc1a68799..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,108 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for BootloaderPrinter.c. - */ - -#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_H_ -#define _BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <avr/io.h> - #include <avr/wdt.h> - #include <avr/power.h> - #include <avr/interrupt.h> - - #include "Descriptors.h" - - #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> - - /* Preprocessor Checks: */ - #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) - #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. - #endif - - /* Macros: */ - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) - - /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ - #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 - - /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ - #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 - - /* Enums: */ - /** Intel HEX parser state machine states. */ - enum HEX_Parser_States_t - { - HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE, /**< Parser is waiting for a HEX Start of Line character. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT, /**< Parser is waiting for a record byte count. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH, /**< Parser is waiting for the MSB of a record address. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW, /**< Parser is waiting for the LSB of a record address. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE, /**< Parser is waiting for the record type. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA, /**< Parser is waiting for more data in the current record. */ - HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM, /**< Parser is waiting for the checksum of the current record. */ - }; - - /** Intel HEX record types, used to indicate the type of record contained in a line of a HEX file. */ - enum HEX_Record_Types_t - { - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_Data = 0, /**< Record contains loadable data. */ - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_EndOfFile = 1, /**< End of file record. */ - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedSegmentAddress = 2, /**< Extended segment start record. */ - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_StartSegmentAddress = 3, /**< Normal segment start record. */ - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedLinearAddress = 4, /**< Extended linear address start record. */ - HEX_RECORD_TYPE_StartLinearAddress = 5, /**< Linear address start record. */ - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - static void SetupHardware(void); - - void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); - void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); - void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); - void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt deleted file mode 100644 index d9aa79686f..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,202 +0,0 @@ -/** \file - * - * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special - * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. - */ - -/** \mainpage Printer Class USB AVR Bootloader - * - * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: - * - * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. - * - * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) - * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) - * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - * - * \section Sec_Info USB Information: - * - * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> - * <td>Device</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> - * <td>Printer Class</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> - * <td>Printer Subclass</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> - * <td>USBIF Printer Class Standard</td> - * </tr> - * <tr> - * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> - * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> - * </tr> - * </table> - * - * \section Sec_Description Project Description: - * - * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a Generic Text Only Printer device, capable of reading and parsing - * "printed" plain-text Intel HEX files to load firmware onto the AVR. - * - * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit - * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to - * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. - * - * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the - * bootloader from the normal user application. - * - * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader - * - * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of - * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. - * - * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from - * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the - * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. - * - * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software - * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). - * - * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. - * - * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board - * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the - * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board - * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the - * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. - * - * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation - * - * This bootloader uses the Generic Text-Only printer drivers inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no - * additional drivers need to be supplied for correct operation. - * - * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application - * - * This bootloader is compatible with Notepad under Windows, and the command line \c lpr utility under Linux. - * - * \subsection SSec_Notepad Notepad (Windows) - * - * While most text applications under Windows will be compatible with the bootloader, the inbuilt Notepad utility - * is recommended as it will introduce minimal formatting changes to the output stream. To program with Notepad, - * open the target HEX file and print it to the Generic Text Only printer device the bootloader creates. - * - * \subsection SSec_LPR LPR (Linux) - * - * While the CUPS framework under Linux will enumerate the bootloader as a Generic Text-Only printer, many - * applications will refuse to print to the device due to the lack of rich formatting options available. As a result, - * under Linux HEX files must be printed via the low level \c lpr utility instead. - * - * \code - * cat Mouse.hex | lpr - * \endcode - * - * \section Sec_API User Application API - * - * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, - * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. - * - * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the - * following layout: - * - * \code - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) - * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) - * - * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); - * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); - * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_SIGNATURE 0xDF20 - * - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) - * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 - * \endcode - * - * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address - * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader - * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them - * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH - * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. - * - * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map - * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. - * - * \verbatim - * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | User Application | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - * | | - * | Bootloader Application | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * | | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 - * | API Table Trampolines | - * | (Not User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 - * | Bootloader API Table | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 - * | Bootloader ID Constants | - * | (User App. Accessible) | - * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - * \endverbatim - * - * - * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: - * - * \par On Linux machines, new firmware fails to be sent to the device via CUPS. - * Only a limited subset of normal printer functionality is exposed via the - * bootloader, causing CUPS to reject print requests from applications that - * are unable to handle true plain-text printing. For best results, the low - * level \c lpr command should be used to print new firmware to the bootloader. - * - * \section Sec_Options Project Options - * - * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. - * - * <table> - * <tr> - * <td> - * None - * </td> - * </tr> - * </table> - */ - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5aa0e765bf..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,93 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File - * - * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, - * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through - * a makefile. - * - * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA - * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". - */ - -#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ -#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ - - #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) - - /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ -// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES - - /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY -// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH - - /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG - #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) - #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY -// #define USB_HOST_ONLY -// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT - #define NO_SOF_EVENTS - - /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ - #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS -// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS - #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL - #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 - #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 - #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 -// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE -// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT - #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP - #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER - - /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ -// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} -// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} -// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT -// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE - - #else - - #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. - - #endif -#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c deleted file mode 100644 index 99625d605a..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,194 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special - * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine - * the device's capabilities and functions. - */ - -#include "Descriptors.h" - - -/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall - * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the - * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration - * process begins. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = -{ - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, - - .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), - .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, - .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, - .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, - - .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, - - .VendorID = 0x03EB, - .ProductID = 0x206B, - .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), - - .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, - .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, - .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS -}; - -/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage - * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces - * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting - * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = -{ - .Config = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, - - .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), - .TotalInterfaces = 1, - - .ConfigurationNumber = 1, - .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, - - .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, - - .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) - }, - - .Printer_Interface = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, - - .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Printer, - .AlternateSetting = 0, - - .TotalEndpoints = 2, - - .Class = PRNT_CSCP_PrinterClass, - .SubClass = PRNT_CSCP_PrinterSubclass, - .Protocol = PRNT_CSCP_BidirectionalProtocol, - - .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR - }, - - .Printer_DataInEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = PRINTER_IN_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - }, - - .Printer_DataOutEndpoint = - { - .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, - - .EndpointAddress = PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR, - .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), - .EndpointSize = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, - .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 - } -}; - -/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests - * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate - * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); - -/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable - * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); - -/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, - * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device - * Descriptor. - */ -const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Printer Bootloader"); - -/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" - * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given - * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function - * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the - * USB host. - */ -uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) -{ - const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); - const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); - - const void* Address = NULL; - uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; - - switch (DescriptorType) - { - case DTYPE_Device: - Address = &DeviceDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); - break; - case DTYPE_Configuration: - Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; - Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); - break; - case DTYPE_String: - switch (DescriptorNumber) - { - case STRING_ID_Language: - Address = &LanguageString; - Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; - break; - case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: - Address = &ManufacturerString; - Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; - break; - case STRING_ID_Product: - Address = &ProductString; - Size = ProductString.Header.Size; - break; - } - - break; - } - - *DescriptorAddress = Address; - return Size; -} - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h deleted file mode 100644 index adb0dddb64..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,96 +0,0 @@ -/* - LUFA Library - Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. - - dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com - www.lufa-lib.org -*/ - -/* - Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) - - Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this - software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted - without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in - all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this - permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting - documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in - advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the - software without specific, written prior permission. - - The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this - software, including all implied warranties of merchantability - and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any - special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages - whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether - in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, - arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of - this software. -*/ - -/** \file - * - * Header file for Descriptors.c. - */ - -#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ -#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ - - /* Includes: */ - #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> - - #include <avr/pgmspace.h> - - /* Macros: */ - /** Endpoint address of the Printer device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ - #define PRINTER_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) - - /** Endpoint address of the Printer host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ - #define PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) - - /** Size in bytes of the Printer data endpoints. */ - #define PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE 64 - - /* Type Defines: */ - /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the - * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which - * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. - */ - typedef struct - { - USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; - - // Printer Interface - USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Printer_Interface; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Printer_DataInEndpoint; - USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Printer_DataOutEndpoint; - } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; - - /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor - * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the - * interface from other descriptors. - */ - enum InterfaceDescriptors_t - { - INTERFACE_ID_Printer = 0, /**< Printer interface descriptor ID */ - }; - - /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should - * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from - * other descriptors. - */ - enum StringDescriptors_t - { - STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ - STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ - STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ - }; - - /* Function Prototypes: */ - uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, - const uint16_t wIndex, - const void** const DescriptorAddress) - ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); - -#endif - diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml deleted file mode 100644 index b5c0c6b3a5..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,159 +0,0 @@ -<asf xmlversion="1.0"> - <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_128kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_64kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="at90usb647"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_32kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega32u4"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_16kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega16u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_8kb_4kb_"> - <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/> - <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> - <generator value="as5_8"/> - - <device-support value="atmega8u2"/> - <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> - - <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/> - - <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> - <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> - - <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/> - - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/> - <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/> - </project> - - <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer" caption="Printer Bootloader"> - <info type="description" value="summary"> - Printer Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device by "printing" new HEX files to the virtual Plain-Text printer it creates when plugged into a host. - </info> - - <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> - - <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> - <keyword value="Bootloaders"/> - <keyword value="USB Device"/> - </info> - - <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> - <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> - - <build type="include-path" value="."/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderPrinter.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderPrinter.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> - <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/> - <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/> - <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/> - - <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> - <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> - - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> - <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderPrinter.txt"/> - - <require idref="lufa.common"/> - <require idref="lufa.platform"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> - <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> - </module> -</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile deleted file mode 100644 index 0f96bb9b73..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2396 +0,0 @@ -# Doxyfile 1.8.9 - -# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system -# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. -# -# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in -# front of the TAG it is preceding. -# -# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. -# The format is: -# TAG = value [value, ...] -# For lists, items can also be appended using: -# TAG += value [value, ...] -# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Project related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file -# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text -# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv -# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv -# for the list of possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by -# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the -# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the -# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. -# The default value is: My Project. - -PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Printer Class Bootloader" - -# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This -# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version -# control system is used. - -PROJECT_NUMBER = - -# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description -# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a -# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. - -PROJECT_BRIEF = - -# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included -# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 -# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy -# the logo to the output directory. - -PROJECT_LOGO = - -# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path -# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is -# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If -# left blank the current directory will be used. - -OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ - -# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- -# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and -# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this -# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where -# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes -# performance problems for the file system. -# The default value is: NO. - -CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO - -# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII -# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII -# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode -# U+3044. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO - -# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all -# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this -# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. -# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, -# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), -# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, -# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), -# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, -# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, -# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, -# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. -# The default value is: English. - -OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English - -# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member -# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class -# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. -# The default value is: YES. - -BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES - -# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief -# description of a member or function before the detailed description -# -# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the -# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. -# The default value is: YES. - -REPEAT_BRIEF = YES - -# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is -# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found -# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text -# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated -# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the -# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of -# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, -# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. - -ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ - "The $name widget" \ - "The $name file" \ - is \ - provides \ - specifies \ - contains \ - represents \ - a \ - an \ - the - -# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then -# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief -# description. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO - -# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all -# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those -# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment -# operators of the base classes will not be shown. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO - -# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path -# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the -# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used -# The default value is: YES. - -FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES - -# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. -# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand -# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. -# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to -# strip. -# -# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which -# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. -# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. - -STRIP_FROM_PATH = - -# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the -# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which -# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of -# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should -# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler -# using the -I flag. - -STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = - -# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but -# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't -# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHORT_NAMES = YES - -# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the -# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief -# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- -# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief -# description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first -# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If -# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus -# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) -# The default value is: NO. - -QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO - -# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a -# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as -# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is -# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this -# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. -# -# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are -# not recognized any more. -# The default value is: NO. - -MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO - -# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the -# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. -# The default value is: YES. - -INHERIT_DOCS = YES - -# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new -# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part -# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. -# The default value is: NO. - -SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO - -# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen -# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. - -TAB_SIZE = 4 - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in -# the documentation. An alias has the form: -# name=value -# For example adding -# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" -# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the -# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading -# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert -# newlines. - -ALIASES = - -# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). -# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" -# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. - -TCL_SUBST = - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources -# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For -# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all -# members will be omitted, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or -# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored -# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, -# qualified scopes will look different, etc. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO - -# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL -# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. -# The default value is: NO. - -OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO - -# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it -# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given -# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it -# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and -# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, -# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: -# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: -# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed -# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For -# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), -# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. -# -# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. -# -# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise -# the files are not read by doxygen. - -EXTENSION_MAPPING = - -# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments -# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable -# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. -# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can -# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in -# case of backward compatibilities issues. -# The default value is: YES. - -MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO - -# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented -# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can -# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or -# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES - -# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want -# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this -# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and -# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); -# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration -# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. -# The default value is: NO. - -BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO - -# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to -# enable parsing support. -# The default value is: NO. - -CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO - -# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: -# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen -# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead -# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. -# The default value is: NO. - -SIP_SUPPORT = NO - -# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate -# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make -# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. -# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple -# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you -# should set this option to NO. -# The default value is: YES. - -IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES - -# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC -# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first -# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default -# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. -# The default value is: NO. - -DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO - -# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type -# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that -# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent -# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the -# \nosubgrouping command. -# The default value is: YES. - -SUBGROUPING = YES - -# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions -# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) -# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX -# and RTF). -# -# Note that this feature does not work in combination with -# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO - -# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions -# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in -# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, -# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set -# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and -# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO - -# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or -# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So -# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct -# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, -# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be -# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound -# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. -# The default value is: NO. - -TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO - -# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This -# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be -# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the -# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small -# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The -# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range -# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 -# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest -# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. - -LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Build related configuration options -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in -# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private -# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the -# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. -# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are -# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ALL = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will -# be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal -# scope will be included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO - -# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_STATIC = YES - -# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined -# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, -# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect -# for Java sources. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES - -# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, -# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are -# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are -# included. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO - -# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be -# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called -# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of -# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace -# are hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these -# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation -# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO - -# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all -# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set -# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option -# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO - -# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend -# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be -# included in the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO - -# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any -# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these -# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO - -# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a -# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation -# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INTERNAL_DOCS = NO - -# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file -# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also -# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ -# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows -# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. -# The default value is: system dependent. - -CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with -# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the -# scope will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO - -# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will -# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to -# YES the compound reference will be hidden. -# The default value is: NO. - -HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO - -# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of -# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES - -# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each -# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader -# which file to include in order to use the member. -# The default value is: NO. - -SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO - -# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include -# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. -# The default value is: NO. - -FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO - -# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the -# documentation for inline members. -# The default value is: YES. - -INLINE_INFO = YES - -# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. -# The default value is: YES. - -SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES - -# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief -# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member -# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that -# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO - -# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the -# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and -# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the -# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. -# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief -# member documentation. -# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting -# detailed member documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO - -# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy -# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will -# appear in their defined order. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO - -# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by -# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will -# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. -# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. -# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical -# list. -# The default value is: NO. - -SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO - -# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper -# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between -# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is -# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a -# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still -# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. -# The default value is: NO. - -STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO - -# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo -# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test -# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug -# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO - -# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) -# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in -# the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES - -# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation -# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> -# ... \endcond blocks. - -ENABLED_SECTIONS = - -# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the -# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the -# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here -# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The -# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be -# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the -# documentation regardless of this setting. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. - -MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 - -# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at -# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the -# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_USED_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This -# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View -# (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_FILES = YES - -# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces -# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the -# Folder Tree View (if specified). -# The default value is: YES. - -SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES - -# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that -# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from -# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via -# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided -# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file -# version. For an example see the documentation. - -FILE_VERSION_FILTER = - -# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed -# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated -# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file -# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can -# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml -# will be used as the name of the layout file. -# -# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called -# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE -# tag is left empty. - -LAYOUT_FILE = - -# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing -# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib -# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool -# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. -# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using -# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the -# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. - -CITE_BIB_FILES = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to -# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the -# messages are off. -# The default value is: NO. - -QUIET = YES - -# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are -# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES -# this implies that the warnings are on. -# -# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARNINGS = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate -# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag -# will automatically be disabled. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES - -# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for -# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters -# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using -# markup commands wrongly. -# The default value is: YES. - -WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES - -# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that -# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return -# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete -# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES - -# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen -# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which -# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated -# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will -# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via -# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) -# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. - -WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" - -# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error -# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard -# error (stderr). - -WARN_LOGFILE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the input files -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain -# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or -# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with -# spaces. -# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. - -INPUT = ./ - -# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files -# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses -# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv -# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of -# possible encodings. -# The default value is: UTF-8. - -INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the -# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, -# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, -# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, -# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, -# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. - -FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ - *.c \ - *.txt - -# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should -# be searched for input files as well. -# The default value is: NO. - -RECURSIVE = YES - -# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be -# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a -# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. -# -# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is -# run. - -EXCLUDE = Documentation/ - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or -# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded -# from the input. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO - -# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude -# certain files from those directories. -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = - -# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names -# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the -# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the -# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, -# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test -# -# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to -# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* - -EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ - INCLUDE_FROM_* - -# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include -# command). - -EXAMPLE_PATH = - -# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the -# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and -# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all -# files are included. - -EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * - -# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be -# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands -# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. -# The default value is: NO. - -EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO - -# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories -# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the -# \image command). - -IMAGE_PATH = - -# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should -# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program -# by executing (via popen()) the command: -# -# <filter> <input-file> -# -# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the -# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter -# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag -# will be ignored. -# -# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the -# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added -# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. - -INPUT_FILTER = - -# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern -# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the -# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter -# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how -# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the -# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. - -FILTER_PATTERNS = - -# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using -# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for -# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). -# The default value is: NO. - -FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO - -# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file -# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and -# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using -# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). -# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. - -FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = - -# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that -# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page -# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub -# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. - -USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to source browsing -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be -# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. -# -# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that -# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. -# The default value is: NO. - -SOURCE_BROWSER = NO - -# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, -# classes and enums directly into the documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -INLINE_SOURCES = NO - -# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any -# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and -# Fortran comments will always remain visible. -# The default value is: YES. - -STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES - -# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented -# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function -# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -REFERENCES_RELATION = NO - -# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set -# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and -# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will -# link to the documentation. -# The default value is: YES. - -REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO - -# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the -# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, -# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this -# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you -# can opt to disable this feature. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES - -# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will -# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in -# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system -# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version -# 4.8.6 or higher. -# -# To use it do the following: -# - Install the latest version of global -# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file -# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree -# - Run doxygen as normal -# -# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these -# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). -# -# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to -# source code will now point to the output of htags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. - -USE_HTAGS = NO - -# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a -# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is -# specified. Set to NO to disable this. -# See also: Section \class. -# The default value is: YES. - -VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO - -# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the -# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the -# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template -# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type -# information. -# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was -# compiled with the --with-libclang option. -# The default value is: NO. - -CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO - -# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command -# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that -# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories -# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. -# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. - -CLANG_OPTIONS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all -# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of -# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. -# The default value is: YES. - -ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES - -# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in -# which the alphabetical index list will be split. -# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 - -# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will -# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag -# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored -# while generating the index headers. -# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. - -IGNORE_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the HTML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_HTML = YES - -# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_OUTPUT = html - -# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each -# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). -# The default value is: .html. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html - -# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for -# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a -# standard header. -# -# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets -# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. -# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a -# default header using -# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css -# YourConfigFile -# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" -# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally -# uses. -# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the -# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description -# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_HEADER = - -# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each -# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard -# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default -# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer -# that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_FOOTER = - -# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style -# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of -# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style -# sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as -# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become -# obsolete. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets -# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. -# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the -# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. -# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). For an example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note -# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the -# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these -# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the -# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_EXTRA_FILES = - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen -# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to -# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value -# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 -# purple, and 360 is red again. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors -# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A -# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 - -# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the -# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 -# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output -# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents -# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not -# change the gamma. -# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 - -# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML -# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this -# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO - -# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML -# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the -# page has loaded. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES - -# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries -# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand -# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to -# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless -# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of -# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value -# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded -# tree by default. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 - -# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development -# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with -# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a -# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in -# that directory and running make install will install the docset in -# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at -# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html -# for more information. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_DOCSET = NO - -# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides -# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider -# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. -# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" - -# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation -# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. -# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify -# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style -# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher - -# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. -# The default value is: Publisher. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. - -DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher - -# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three -# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The -# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop -# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on -# Windows. -# -# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output -# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML -# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old -# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed -# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for -# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for -# compressed HTML files. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO - -# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm -# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be -# written to the html output directory. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_FILE = - -# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path -# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, -# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. -# The file has to be specified with full path. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -HHC_LOCATION = - -# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated -# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -GENERATE_CHI = NO - -# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) -# and project file content. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = - -# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated -# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it -# enables the Previous and Next buttons. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -BINARY_TOC = NO - -# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to -# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. - -TOC_EXPAND = YES - -# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and -# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that -# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help -# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_QHP = NO - -# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify -# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to -# the HTML output folder. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QCH_FILE = - -# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help -# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace -# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project - -# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt -# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual -# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- -# folders). -# The default value is: doc. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc - -# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom -# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = - -# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the -# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom -# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- -# filters). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this -# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: -# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = - -# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's -# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the -# generated .qhp file. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. - -QHG_LOCATION = - -# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be -# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To -# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in -# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs -# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory -# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. -# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO - -# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin -# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this -# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. -# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. - -ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project - -# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might -# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The -# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top -# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables -# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation -# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -DISABLE_INDEX = YES - -# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index -# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag -# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like -# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this -# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required -# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the -# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can -# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style -# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at -# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has -# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting -# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES - -# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that -# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. -# -# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing -# in the overview section. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 - -# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used -# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 - -# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to -# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO - -# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in -# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful -# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML -# output directory to force them to be regenerated. -# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images -# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not -# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. -# -# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in -# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see -# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering -# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX -# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When -# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path -# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -USE_MATHJAX = NO - -# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for -# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: -# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. -# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best -# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. -# The default value is: HTML-CSS. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS - -# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML -# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory -# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory -# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then -# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax -# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing -# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of -# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. -# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest - -# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax -# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example -# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = - -# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces -# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site -# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an -# example see the documentation. -# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. - -MATHJAX_CODEFILE = - -# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for -# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and -# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help -# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) -# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. -# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then -# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to -# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S -# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically -# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down -# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated -# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel -# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the -# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> -# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter -# option. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE = NO - -# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be -# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There -# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH -# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and -# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing -# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section -# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO - -# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP -# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file -# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an -# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the -# search results. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). -# -# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO - -# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server -# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. -# -# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine -# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library -# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and -# Searching" for details. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHENGINE_URL = - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed -# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the -# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. -# The default file is: searchdata.xml. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml - -# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the -# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is -# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple -# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = - -# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen -# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are -# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a -# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of -# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: -# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. - -EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. -# The default value is: YES. - -GENERATE_LATEX = NO - -# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_OUTPUT = latex - -# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be -# invoked. -# -# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating -# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is -# written to the output directory. -# The default file is: latex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex - -# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate -# index for LaTeX. -# The default file is: makeindex. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex - -# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -COMPACT_LATEX = NO - -# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the -# printer. -# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x -# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). -# The default value is: a4. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PAPER_TYPE = a4wide - -# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names -# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for -# instance you can specify -# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times -# If left blank no extra packages will be included. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -EXTRA_PACKAGES = - -# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the -# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See -# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the -# default header to a separate file. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The -# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, -# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, -# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty -# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred -# to HTML_HEADER. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HEADER = - -# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the -# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last -# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See -# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what -# special commands can be used inside the footer. -# -# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_FOOTER = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined -# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created -# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen -# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. -# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last -# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the -# list). -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = - -# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or -# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output -# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or -# markers available. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = - -# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is -# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will -# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This -# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES - -# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate -# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a -# higher quality PDF documentation. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -USE_PDFLATEX = YES - -# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode -# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running -# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used -# when generating formulas in HTML. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO - -# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the -# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO - -# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source -# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the -# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See -# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. -# The default value is: plain. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. - -LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the RTF output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The -# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF -# readers/editors. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_RTF = NO - -# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: rtf. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_OUTPUT = rtf - -# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF -# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some -# trees in general. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -COMPACT_RTF = NO - -# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will -# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML -# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online -# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those -# fields. -# -# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO - -# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config -# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, -# missing definitions are set to their default value. -# -# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the -# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = - -# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is -# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated -# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = - -# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code -# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. -# -# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as -# SOURCE_BROWSER. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. - -RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the man page output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for -# classes and files. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_MAN = NO - -# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by -# MAN_OUTPUT. -# The default directory is: man. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_OUTPUT = man - -# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated -# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number -# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is -# optional. -# The default value is: .3. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_EXTENSION = .3 - -# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within -# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by -# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_SUBDIR = - -# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it -# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real -# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without -# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. - -MAN_LINKS = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the XML output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that -# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_XML = NO - -# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a -# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of -# it. -# The default directory is: xml. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_OUTPUT = xml - -# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program -# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to -# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size -# of the XML output. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. - -XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files -# that can be used to generate PDF. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO - -# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. -# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in -# front of it. -# The default directory is: docbook. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook - -# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the -# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing -# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly -# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. - -DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an -# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the -# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is -# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the Perl module output -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module -# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. -# -# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. -# The default value is: NO. - -GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary -# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI -# output from the Perl module output. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_LATEX = NO - -# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely -# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to -# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the -# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it -# just the same. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES - -# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are -# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful -# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't -# overwrite each other's variables. -# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. - -PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the preprocessor -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all -# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. -# The default value is: YES. - -ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names -# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be -# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting -# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -MACRO_EXPANSION = YES - -# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then -# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and -# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES - -# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the -# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES - -# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the -# preprocessor. -# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_PATH = - -# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard -# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the -# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be -# used. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = - -# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are -# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. -# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or -# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" -# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or -# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ - PROGMEM \ - ATTR_NO_INIT - -# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this -# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The -# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED -# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the -# definition found in the source code. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = - -# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will -# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have -# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros -# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not -# removed. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. - -SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to external references -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag -# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of -# a tag file without this location is as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... -# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: -# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... -# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the -# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use -# of tag files. -# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include -# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is -# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. - -TAGFILES = - -# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a -# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to -# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. - -GENERATE_TAGFILE = - -# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in -# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be -# listed. -# The default value is: NO. - -ALLEXTERNALS = NO - -# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed -# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be -# listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES - -# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in -# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will -# be listed. -# The default value is: YES. - -EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES - -# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script -# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). -# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. - -PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl - -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Configuration options related to the dot tool -#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram -# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to -# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT -# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more -# powerful graphs. -# The default value is: YES. - -CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO - -# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc -# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: -# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the -# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where -# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the -# default search path. - -MSCGEN_PATH = - -# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will -# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The -# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. -# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. - -DIA_PATH = - -# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance -# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. -# The default value is: YES. - -HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES - -# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is -# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: -# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent -# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is -# set to NO -# The default value is: NO. - -HAVE_DOT = NO - -# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed -# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of -# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value -# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing -# speed. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 - -# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen -# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make -# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a -# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by -# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. -# The default value is: Helvetica. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTNAME = - -# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of -# dot graphs. -# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 - -# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with -# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set -# the path where dot can find it using this tag. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_FONTPATH = - -# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. -# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CLASS_GRAPH = NO - -# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a -# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation -# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the -# class with other documented classes. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for -# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GROUP_GRAPHS = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and -# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling -# Language. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LOOK = NO - -# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the -# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may -# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the -# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 -# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit -# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, -# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to -# 10. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 - -# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and -# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their -# instances. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO - -# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to -# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the -# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO - -# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are -# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing -# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented -# files. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callgraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALL_GRAPH = NO - -# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller -# dependency graph for every global function or class method. -# -# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. -# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected -# functions only using the \callergraph command. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -CALLER_GRAPH = NO - -# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical -# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO - -# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the -# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The -# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the -# files in the directories. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO - -# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images -# generated by dot. -# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order -# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this -# requirement). -# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. -# The default value is: png. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png - -# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to -# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. -# -# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested -# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. -# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make -# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO - -# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be -# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_PATH = - -# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile -# command). -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOTFILE_DIRS = - -# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile -# command). - -MSCFILE_DIRS = - -# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that -# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile -# command). - -DIAFILE_DIRS = - -# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the -# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed -# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will -# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and -# will not generate output for the diagram. - -PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = - -# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by -# the !include statement in a plantuml block. - -PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = - -# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes -# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes -# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized -# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct -# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that -# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 - -# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs -# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the -# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay -# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 -# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also -# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by -# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. -# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 - -# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent -# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem -# to support this out of the box. -# -# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to -# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to -# read). -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES - -# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output -# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This -# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support -# this, this feature is disabled by default. -# The default value is: NO. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO - -# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page -# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated -# graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -GENERATE_LEGEND = YES - -# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot -# files that are used to generate the various graphs. -# The default value is: YES. -# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. - -DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index 1de35bba02..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# -# -------------------------------------- -# LUFA Project Makefile. -# -------------------------------------- - -# Run "make help" for target help. - -MCU = at90usb1287 -ARCH = AVR8 -BOARD = USBKEY -F_CPU = 8000000 -F_USB = $(F_CPU) -OPTIMIZATION = s -TARGET = BootloaderPrinter -SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) -LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA -CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) - -# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must -# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the -# device's fuses. -FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128 -BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8 - -# Bootloader address calculation formulas -# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. -CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) -BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) -BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) - -# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to -# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. -BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) -BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) - -# Default target -all: - -# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules -DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk -include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk - -# Include common DMBS build system modules -DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS -include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk -include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile deleted file mode 100644 index e030ad44ab..0000000000 --- a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile +++ /dev/null @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -# -# LUFA Library -# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. -# -# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com -# www.lufa-lib.org -# - -# Makefile to build all the LUFA USB Bootloaders. Call with "make all" to -# rebuild all bootloaders. - -# Bootloaders are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any -# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled -# code. - -PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) - -# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad -# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if -# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. -ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) - $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) -endif - -# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory -ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) - # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build - ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) - MAKECMDGOALS := clean all - .NOTPARALLEL: - endif - - # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build - ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) - MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) - .NOTPARALLEL: - endif -endif - -%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) - @echo . > /dev/null - -$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): - @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) - -.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) |